blob: 73bb2f4a05169fe003518cbb17a32a7639fdcf3d [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau33205c22020-07-07 16:35:28 +02005 version 2.3
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau3a00c912020-07-07 16:33:14 +02007 2020/07/07
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200563.9. Rings
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020057
584. Proxies
594.1. Proxy keywords matrix
604.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
61
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100625. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200635.1. Bind options
645.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200655.3. Server DNS resolution
665.3.1. Global overview
675.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020068
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100696. Cache
706.1. Limitation
716.2. Setup
726.2.1. Cache section
736.2.2. Proxy section
74
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200757. Using ACLs and fetching samples
767.1. ACL basics
777.1.1. Matching booleans
787.1.2. Matching integers
797.1.3. Matching strings
807.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
817.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
827.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
837.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
847.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200857.3.1. Converters
867.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
877.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
887.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
897.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
907.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200917.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200927.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020093
948. Logging
958.1. Log levels
968.2. Log formats
978.2.1. Default log format
988.2.2. TCP log format
998.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001008.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001018.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001028.3. Advanced logging options
1038.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1048.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1058.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1068.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1078.4. Timing events
1088.5. Session state at disconnection
1098.6. Non-printable characters
1108.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1118.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1128.9. Examples of logs
113
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001149. Supported filters
1159.1. Trace
1169.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001179.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001189.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001199.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200120
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012110. FastCGI applications
12210.1. Setup
12310.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12410.1.2. Proxy section
12510.1.3. Example
12610.2. Default parameters
12710.3. Limitations
128
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129
1301. Quick reminder about HTTP
131----------------------------
132
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100133When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200134fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
135on almost anything found in the contents.
136
137However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
138formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
139correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
140
141
1421.1. The HTTP transaction model
143-------------------------------
144
145The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100146to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100147from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
148connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149will involve a new connection :
150
151 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
152
153In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
154establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
155by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
156length.
157
158Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
159to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
160however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
161response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
162header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
163
164 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
165
166Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
167power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
168but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200169a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100171Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
173second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
174page :
175
176 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
177
178This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
179latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
180correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
181the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100182server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100184The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
185time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
186are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
187parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
188carry the stream identifier.
189
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100190By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
191connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
192leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100193start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
194processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
195waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200196
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200197HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100198 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
199 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100200 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100201 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200202 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100203
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100204
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200205
2061.2. HTTP request
207-----------------
208
209First, let's consider this HTTP request :
210
211 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100212 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200213 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
214 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
215 3 User-agent: my small browser
216 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
217 5 Accept: image/png
218
219
2201.2.1. The Request line
221-----------------------
222
223Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
224
225 - a METHOD : GET
226 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
227 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
228
229All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
230which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
231followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
232is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
233desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
234the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
235
236The URI itself can have several forms :
237
238 - A "relative URI" :
239
240 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
241
242 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
243 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
244
245 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
246
247 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
248
249 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
250 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
251 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
252 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
253 must accept this form too.
254
255 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
256 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
257 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100258
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200259 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
260 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
261 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
262 other protocols too.
263
264In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
265mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
266on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
267It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
268specific to the language, framework or application in use.
269
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100270HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100271assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100272
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200273
2741.2.2. The request headers
275--------------------------
276
277The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
278beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
279an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
280Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
281values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
282encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
283the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
284define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
285
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100286Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200287their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100288"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200289as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
290normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
291representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
292HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200293
294The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
295that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
296is one valid form of empty line.
297
298Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
299headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
300about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
301application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
302
303Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000304 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200305 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
306 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
307 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
308
309
3101.3. HTTP response
311------------------
312
313An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
314messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
315
316 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100317 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200318 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
319 2 Content-length: 350
320 3 Content-Type: text/html
321
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200322As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
323codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
324response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100325continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
326the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
327following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
328sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
329(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
330correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
331such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
332state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
333over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
334if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
335information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200336
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200337
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003381.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200339------------------------
340
341Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
342
343 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
344 - a status code : 200
345 - a reason : OK
346
347The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100348 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
349 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
350 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
351 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
352 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200353
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000354Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100355"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200356found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
357messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
358or "Authentication Required".
359
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100360HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200361
362 Code When / reason
363 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
364 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
365 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
366 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100367 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
368 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200369 400 for an invalid or too large request
370 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
371 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200372 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100373 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200374 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100375 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
376 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200377 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
378 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
379 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200380 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
382 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
383 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
384
385The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3864.2).
387
388
3891.3.2. The response headers
390---------------------------
391
392Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
393the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
394details.
395
396
3972. Configuring HAProxy
398----------------------
399
4002.1. Configuration file format
401------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200402
403HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
404
405 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
406 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
407 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
408 "frontend" and "backend".
409
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100410The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
411referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200412delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100413
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200414
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004152.2. Quoting and escaping
416-------------------------
417
418HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
419many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
420with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
421single quotes.
422
423If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
424them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
425escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
426
427Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
428
429 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
430 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
431 \\ to use a backslash
432 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
433 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
434
435Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
436the interpretation of:
437
438 space as a parameter separator
439 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
440 # hash as a comment start
441
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200442Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
443-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
444backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
445
446Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200447quoting.
448
449Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
450nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
451
452Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
453equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
454
455 Example:
456 # those are equivalents:
457 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
458 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
459 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
460 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
461 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
462
463 # those are equivalents:
464 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
465 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
466 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
467 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
468
469
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004702.3. Environment variables
471--------------------------
472
473HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
474interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
475configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
476optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
477shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
478underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
479
480 Example:
481
482 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
483
484 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
485
486 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
487
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200488Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
489file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200490
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200491* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
492 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
493
494* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
495 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
496 directory.
497
498* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
499
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500500* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200501 processes, separated by semicolons.
502
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500503* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200504 CLI, separated by semicolons.
505
506See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200507
5082.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200509----------------
510
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100511Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100512values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
513otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
514numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
515for every keyword. Supported units are :
516
517 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
518 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
519 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
520 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
521 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
522 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
523
524
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005252.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200526-------------
527
528 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
529 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
530 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
531 global
532 daemon
533 maxconn 256
534
535 defaults
536 mode http
537 timeout connect 5000ms
538 timeout client 50000ms
539 timeout server 50000ms
540
541 frontend http-in
542 bind *:80
543 default_backend servers
544
545 backend servers
546 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
547
548
549 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
550 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
551 global
552 daemon
553 maxconn 256
554
555 defaults
556 mode http
557 timeout connect 5000ms
558 timeout client 50000ms
559 timeout server 50000ms
560
561 listen http-in
562 bind *:80
563 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
564
565
566Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
567
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100568 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200569
570
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005713. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200572--------------------
573
574Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
575are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
576of them have command-line equivalents.
577
578The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
579
580 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200581 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200582 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200583 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200584 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200585 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200586 - description
587 - deviceatlas-json-file
588 - deviceatlas-log-level
589 - deviceatlas-separator
590 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900591 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200592 - gid
593 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100594 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200595 - h1-case-adjust
596 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100597 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100598 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100599 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200600 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200601 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200602 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100603 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200604 - lua-load
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100605 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200606 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200607 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200608 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200609 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200610 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +0200611 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100612 - presetenv
613 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200614 - uid
615 - ulimit-n
616 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200617 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100618 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200619 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200620 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200621 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +0200622 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200623 - ssl-default-bind-options
624 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200625 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200626 - ssl-default-server-options
627 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100628 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +0200629 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100630 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100631 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100632 - 51degrees-data-file
633 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200634 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200635 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200636 - wurfl-data-file
637 - wurfl-information-list
638 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200639 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100640 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100641
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200642 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100643 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200644 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200645 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200646 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100647 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100648 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100649 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200650 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200651 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200652 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200653 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200654 - noepoll
655 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000656 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200657 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100658 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300659 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000660 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100661 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200662 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200663 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200664 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000665 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000666 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200667 - tune.buffers.limit
668 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200669 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200670 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100671 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +0200672 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200673 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200674 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200675 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100676 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200677 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200678 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +0200679 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100680 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100681 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100682 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100683 - tune.lua.session-timeout
684 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200685 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100686 - tune.maxaccept
687 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200688 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200689 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200690 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +0200691 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
692 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100693 - tune.rcvbuf.client
694 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100695 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200696 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +0200697 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100698 - tune.sndbuf.client
699 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100700 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +0200701 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100702 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200703 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100704 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200705 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200706 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100707 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200708 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100709 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200710 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
711 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
712 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100713 - tune.zlib.memlevel
714 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100715
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200716 * Debugging
717 - debug
718 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +0200719 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200720
721
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007223.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200723------------------------------------
724
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200725ca-base <dir>
726 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +0100727 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
728 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
729 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200730
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200731chroot <jail dir>
732 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
733 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
734 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
735 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
736 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100737 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100738
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100739cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
740 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
741 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
742 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
743 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
744 set. These sets have the format
745
746 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
747
748 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100749 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100750 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
751 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100752 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
753 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100754 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100755 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100756 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100757 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100758 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
759 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
760 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
761 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100762
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100763 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
764 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
765 on the machine's word size.
766
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100767 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100768 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
769 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
770 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
771 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
772 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
773 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100774
775 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100776 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
777
778 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
779 # first 4 CPUs
780
781 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
782 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
783 # word size.
784
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100785 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100786 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100787 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
788 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
789 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
790
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100791 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
792 # and so on.
793 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
794 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
795 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
796
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100797 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100798 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
799 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
800 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
801
802 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
803 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
804 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
805
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100806 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
807 # and a thread range.
808 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
809 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
810 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
811
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200812crt-base <dir>
813 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +0100814 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
815 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200816
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200817daemon
818 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
819 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100820 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
821 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200822
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200823deviceatlas-json-file <path>
824 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100825 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200826
827deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100828 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200829 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
830
831deviceatlas-separator <char>
832 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
833 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
834
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100835deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200836 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
837 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
838 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100839
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900840external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100841 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
842 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100843 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
844 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
845 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
846 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
847 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900848
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200849gid <number>
850 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
851 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
852 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100853 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
854 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200855 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100856
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100857group <group name>
858 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
859 See also "gid" and "user".
860
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100861hard-stop-after <time>
862 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
863
864 Arguments :
865 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
866 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
867 SIGUSR1 signal.
868
869 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
870 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
871 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
872
873 Example:
874 global
875 hard-stop-after 30s
876
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200877h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
878 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
879 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
880 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
881 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +0500882 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200883 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
884 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
885 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
886 specified in a proxy.
887
888 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
889 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
890 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
891 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
892 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
893 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
894 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
895
896 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
897 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
898 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
899 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
900 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
901
902 Example:
903 global
904 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
905
906 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
907 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
908
909h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
910 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
911 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
912 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
913 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
914 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
915 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
916 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
917 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
918
919 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
920 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
921 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
922
923 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
924 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
925
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100926insecure-fork-wanted
927 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
928 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
929 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
930 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
931 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
932 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
933 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
934 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
935 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
936 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
937 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
938 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
939 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
940 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
941 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
942 disable it.
943
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100944insecure-setuid-wanted
945 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
946 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
947 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
948 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
949 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
950 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
951 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
952 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
953 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
954 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
955 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
956 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
957 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
958 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
959
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100960issuers-chain-path <dir>
961 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
962 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
963 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
964 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
965 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
966 "issuers-chain-path".
967 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
968 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
969 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
970 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
971 will share the chain in memory.
972
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200973localpeer <name>
974 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
975 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
976 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
977 the configuration parsing.
978
979 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
980 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
981
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200982log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
983 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100984 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100985 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100986 configured with "log global".
987
988 <address> can be one of:
989
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100990 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100991 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
992 port).
993
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100994 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
995 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
996 port).
997
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100998 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100999 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1000 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001001 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001002
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001003 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1004 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1005 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1006 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1007 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1008 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1009 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1010 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1011 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1012 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1013 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1014 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1015 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1016 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001017 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1018 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001019
1020 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1021 "fd@2", see above.
1022
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001023 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1024 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1025 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1026 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1027 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1028
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001029 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1030 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001031
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001032 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1033 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1034 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1035 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1036 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1037 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1038 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1039 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1040 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1041 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001042 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1043 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001044
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001045 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1046 one of the following :
1047
1048 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
1049 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1050
1051 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1052 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1053
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001054 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1055 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1056 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1057 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1058 logger consumes.
1059
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001060 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1061 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1062 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1063 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1064
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001065 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1066 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1067 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1068 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1069 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1070
1071 <sample_size>
1072 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1073 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1074 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1075 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1076 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1077
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001078 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001079
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001080 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1081 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1082 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1083
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001084 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1085 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1086 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1087 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001088
1089 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001090 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1091 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1092 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1093 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1094 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1095 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001096
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001097 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001098
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001099log-send-hostname [<string>]
1100 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1101 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1102 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1103 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1104 the logs.
1105
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001106log-tag <string>
1107 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1108 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1109 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001110 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001111
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001112lua-load <file>
1113 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1114 used multiple times.
1115
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001116lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1117 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1118 variable.
1119 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1120 to "path".
1121
1122 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1123 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1124 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1125 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1126 will be checked earlier.
1127
1128 As an example by specifying the following path:
1129
1130 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1131 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1132
1133 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1134 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1135 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1136 paths if that does not exist either.
1137
1138 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1139 documentation.
1140
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001141master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001142 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1143 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1144 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001145 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001146 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1147 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001148 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1149 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1150 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1151 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1152 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001153
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001154 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001155
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001156mworker-max-reloads <number>
1157 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001158 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001159 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1160 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1161 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1162
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001163nbproc <number>
1164 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1165 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1166 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001167 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1168 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001169 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1170 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001171
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001172nbthread <number>
1173 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001174 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1175 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1176 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1177 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1178 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001179 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1180 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1181 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1182 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1183 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1184 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1185 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001186
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001187pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001188 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001189 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1190 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1191
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001192pp2-never-send-local
1193 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1194 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1195 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1196 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1197 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1198 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1199 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1200 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1201 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1202 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1203 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1204
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001205presetenv <name> <value>
1206 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1207 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1208 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1209 and "unsetenv".
1210
1211resetenv [<name> ...]
1212 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1213 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1214 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1215 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1216 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1217 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1218 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1219 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1220
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001221stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001222 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1223 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1224 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1225 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1226 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1227 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001228 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001229 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1230 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1231 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1232 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001233
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001234server-state-base <directory>
1235 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001236 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1237 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001238
1239server-state-file <file>
1240 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1241 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1242 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1243 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1244 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1245 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1246 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1247 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001248 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1249 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001250
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001251setenv <name> <value>
1252 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1253 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1254 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1255 and "unsetenv".
1256
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001257set-dumpable
1258 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001259 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1260 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1261 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1262 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1263 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1264 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1265 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1266 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1267 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1268 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1269 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1270 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1271 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1272 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1273 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1274 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1275 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001276
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001277ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1278 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1279 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001280 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001281 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001282 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1283 information and recommendations see e.g.
1284 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1285 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1286 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1287 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001288
1289ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1290 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1291 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1292 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1293 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1294 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001295 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1296 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1297 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001298 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001299
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001300ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1301 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1302 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1303 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1304 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1305 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1306
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001307ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1308 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1309 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1310 keyword to see available options.
1311
1312 Example:
1313 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001314 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001315
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001316ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1317 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1318 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001319 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001320 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001321 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1322 information and recommendations see e.g.
1323 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1324 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1325 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1326 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1327 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001328
1329ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1330 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1331 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1332 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1333 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1334 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001335 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1336 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1337 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1338 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001339
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001340ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1341 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1342 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1343 keyword to see available options.
1344
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001345ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1346 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1347 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1348 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001349 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001350 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001351 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1352 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1353 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1354 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001355 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1356 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1357 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1358
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001359ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001360 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
1361 the loading of the SSL certificates.
1362
1363 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1364 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1365 optimize the startup time.
1366
1367 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1368 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1369 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1370
1371 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001372 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001373
1374 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
1375 will try to load a certificate bundle. This is done by looking for
1376 <basename>.rsa, .ecdsa and .dsa. In the case of directories, HAProxy will
1377 try to gather the files with the same basename in a multi-certificate bundle.
1378 The bundles were introduced with OpenSSL 1.0.2 and were the only way back
1379 then to load an ECDSA certificate and a RSA one, with the same SNI. Since
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001380 OpenSSL 1.1.1 it is not recommended anymore, you can specify both the ECDSA
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001381 and the RSA file on the bind line.
1382
1383 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1384
1385 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1386
1387 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1388 not provided in the PEM file.
1389
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001390 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1391 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1392
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001393 The default behavior is "all".
1394
1395 Example:
1396 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1397 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1398 ssl-load-extra-files none
1399
1400 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1401
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001402ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1403 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1404 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1405 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1406
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001407ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04001408 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001409 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1410 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1411 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1412 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1413 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1414 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
1415 bits does not need it.
1416
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001417stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1418 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1419 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1420 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001421 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001422 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001423
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001424 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1425 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1426 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001427
1428stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1429 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1430 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001431 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001432
1433stats maxconn <connections>
1434 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1435 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1436
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001437uid <number>
1438 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1439 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1440 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1441 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1442
1443ulimit-n <number>
1444 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1445 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1446 option.
1447
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001448unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1449 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1450
1451 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1452 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1453 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1454 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1455 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1456 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1457 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1458 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1459 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1460 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1461
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001462unsetenv [<name> ...]
1463 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1464 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1465 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1466 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1467 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1468 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1469 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1470
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001471user <user name>
1472 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1473 See also "uid" and "group".
1474
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001475node <name>
1476 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1477
1478 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1479 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1480 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1481 traffic.
1482
1483description <text>
1484 Add a text that describes the instance.
1485
1486 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1487 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1488 "<" and ">" characters.
1489
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100149051degrees-data-file <file path>
1491 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001492 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001493
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001494 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001495 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1496
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000149751degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001498 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1499 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1500 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1501
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001502 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001503 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1504
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200150551degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001506 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1507 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1508
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001509 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1510 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1511
151251degrees-cache-size <number>
1513 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1514 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1515 By default, this cache is disabled.
1516
1517 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001518 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1519
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001520wurfl-data-file <file path>
1521 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1522 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1523
1524 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1525 with USE_WURFL=1.
1526
1527wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1528 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1529 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1530 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1531
1532 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1533
1534 Valid WURFL properties are:
1535 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1536
1537 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1538 device.
1539
1540 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1541 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1542
1543 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1544 particular web request.
1545
1546 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1547 used Libwurfl API version.
1548
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001549 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1550 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1551
1552 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1553 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1554
1555 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1556
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001557 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1558 with USE_WURFL=1.
1559
1560wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1561 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1562 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1563
1564 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1565 with USE_WURFL=1.
1566
1567wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1568 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1569 thus before the chroot.
1570
1571 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1572 with USE_WURFL=1.
1573
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001574wurfl-cache-size <size>
1575 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1576 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001577 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001578 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001579
1580 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1581 with USE_WURFL=1.
1582
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001583strict-limits
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01001584 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy tries to set the
1585 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
1586 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
1587 haproxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
1588 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001589
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015903.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001591-----------------------
1592
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001593busy-polling
1594 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1595 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1596 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1597 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1598 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1599 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1600 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1601 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1602 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1603 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1604 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1605 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1606 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1607 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1608 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1609 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1610 "poll" pollers.
1611
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001612 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1613 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1614 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1615
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001616max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1617 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1618 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1619 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1620 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1621 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1622 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1623 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1624 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1625
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001626maxconn <number>
1627 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1628 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1629 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001630 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1631 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1632 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1633 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001634 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1635 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1636 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1637 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1638 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1639 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001640
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001641maxconnrate <number>
1642 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1643 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1644 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1645 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1646 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1647 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1648 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1649 fairness.
1650
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001651maxcomprate <number>
1652 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001653 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001654 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1655 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1656 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001657 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001658 default value.
1659
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001660maxcompcpuusage <number>
1661 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1662 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1663 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1664 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1665 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1666 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1667 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1668 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1669
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001670maxpipes <number>
1671 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1672 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1673 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1674 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1675 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1676 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1677
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001678maxsessrate <number>
1679 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1680 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1681 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1682 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1683 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1684 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1685 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1686 fairness.
1687
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001688maxsslconn <number>
1689 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1690 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1691 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1692 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1693 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1694 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1695 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001696 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1697 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1698 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1699 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1700 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1701 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1702 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001703
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001704maxsslrate <number>
1705 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1706 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1707 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1708 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1709 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1710 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1711 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1712 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1713 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1714 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1715
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001716maxzlibmem <number>
1717 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1718 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1719 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001720 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1721 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1722 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1723
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001724noepoll
1725 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1726 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001727 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001728
1729nokqueue
1730 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1731 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1732 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1733
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001734noevports
1735 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1736 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1737 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1738 also "nopoll".
1739
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001740nopoll
1741 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1742 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001743 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001744 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1745 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001746
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001747nosplice
1748 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001749 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001750 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001751 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001752 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1753 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1754 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1755 "option splice-response".
1756
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001757nogetaddrinfo
1758 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1759 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1760
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001761noreuseport
1762 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1763 command line argument "-dR".
1764
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001765profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1766 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1767 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1768 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1769 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001770 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001771 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1772 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1773 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1774 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1775
1776 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1777 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1778 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1779 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1780 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001781 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1782 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1783 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1784 CLI.
1785
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001786spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001787 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1788 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1789 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1790 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1791 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1792 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001793
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001794ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001795 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001796 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001797 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1798 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1799 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1800 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1801 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001802 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1803 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001804 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1805 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1806 openssl configuration file uses:
1807 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1808
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001809ssl-mode-async
1810 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001811 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001812 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1813 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1814 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001815 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001816 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001817
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001818tune.buffers.limit <number>
1819 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1820 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1821 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1822 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1823 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001824 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001825 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1826 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1827 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1828 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1829 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1830 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1831 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1832 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1833 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1834
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001835tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1836 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1837 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1838 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1839 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1840
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001841tune.bufsize <number>
1842 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1843 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1844 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1845 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1846 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1847 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1848 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001849 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1850 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1851 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001852 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001853 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1854 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1855 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001856
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001857tune.chksize <number>
1858 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1859 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1860 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1861 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1862 checks whenever possible.
1863
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001864tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1865 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1866 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1867 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1868 this value. The default value is 1.
1869
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001870tune.fail-alloc
1871 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1872 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1873 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1874 gracefully.
1875
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001876tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
1877 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
1878 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
1879 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
1880 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
1881 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
1882
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001883tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1884 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1885 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1886 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1887 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1888 change it.
1889
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001890tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1891 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001892 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1893 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001894 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1895 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1896 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1897 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1898 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1899
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001900tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1901 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1902 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1903 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1904 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1905 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1906 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1907 recommended not to change this value.
1908
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001909tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1910 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1911 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1912 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1913 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1914 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1915 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1916 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1917
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001918tune.http.cookielen <number>
1919 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1920 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1921 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1922 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1923 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1924 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1925 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1926 to change this value.
1927
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001928tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001929 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1930 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001931 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001932 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001933 configuration directives too.
1934 The default value is 1024.
1935
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001936tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1937 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1938 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1939 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1940 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1941 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1942 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001943 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1944 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1945 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001946
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001947tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
1948 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
1949 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
1950 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
1951 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
1952 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
1953 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
1954 this option to "off". The default is on.
1955
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001956tune.idletimer <timeout>
1957 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1958 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1959 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1960 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1961 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1962 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001963 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001964 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001965 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1966
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001967tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1968 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1969 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1970 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1971 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1972 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1973 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1974 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1975 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1976 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1977
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001978tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1979 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001980 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001981 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1982 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001983 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001984 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1985 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1986
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001987tune.lua.maxmem
1988 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1989 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1990 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1991 memory.
1992
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001993tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1994 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001995 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1996 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001997 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001998
1999tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2000 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2001 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2002 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2003 check servers.
2004
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002005tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2006 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2007 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2008 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002009 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002010
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002011tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002012 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2013 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
2014 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
2015 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
2016 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
2017 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
2018 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
2019 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
2020 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
2021 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002022
2023tune.maxpollevents <number>
2024 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2025 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2026 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2027 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2028 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2029
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002030tune.maxrewrite <number>
2031 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2032 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2033 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2034 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2035 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2036 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2037 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2038 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2039 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2040 bufsize.
2041
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002042tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2043 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2044 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2045 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2046 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2047 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2048 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2049 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2050 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2051 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002052 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2053 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002054 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2055 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2056 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2057 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2058 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2059 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2060 setting this parameter to 0.
2061
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002062tune.pipesize <number>
2063 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2064 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2065 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2066 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2067 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2068 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2069
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002070tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2071 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2072 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2073 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2074 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2075 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2076 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002077 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002078
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002079tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2080 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2081 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2082 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2083 default is 20.
2084
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002085tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2086tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2087 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2088 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2089 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002090 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002091 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002092 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2093 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2094
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002095tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002096 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002097 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2098 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2099 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2100 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2101
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002102tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002103 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002104 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002105 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead. When
2106 experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2107 tune.sched.low-latency to limit the maximum latency to the lowest possible.
2108
2109tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2110 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
2111 haproxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
2112 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2113 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2114 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2115 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2116 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2117 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2118 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002119
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002120tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2121tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2122 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2123 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2124 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002125 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002126 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002127 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2128 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2129 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2130 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2131 notifying haproxy again.
2132
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002133tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002134 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
2135 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
2136 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002137 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002138 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002139 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002140 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
2141 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
2142 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01002143 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
2144 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002145
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002146tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002147 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002148 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2149 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2150 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2151 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2152 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2153
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002154tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2155 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2156 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2157 performances. This is disabled by default.
2158
2159 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2160 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2161
2162 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2163
2164 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2165
2166 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2167
2168 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2169 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2170 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2171
2172 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2173 converted.
2174
2175 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2176 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2177 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2178 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2179 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2180 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2181 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002182 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2183 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002184
2185 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2186
2187 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2188 only need this line:
2189
2190 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2191
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002192tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2193 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002194 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002195 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2196 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2197 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2198 being used for too long.
2199
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002200tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2201 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2202 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2203 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2204 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2205 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2206 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2207 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2208 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2209 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2210 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002211 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002212 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002213
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002214tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2215 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2216 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2217 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2218 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002219 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002220 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2221 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002222 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2223 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002224
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002225tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2226 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2227 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2228 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2229 1000 entries.
2230
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002231tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2232 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2233 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2234 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2235
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002236tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002237tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002238tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2239tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2240tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002241 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2242 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2243 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2244 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2245 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2246 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2247 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2248 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002249
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002250 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2251 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2252 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2253 all available space is consumed.
2254 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2255 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2256 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002257
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002258tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2259 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002260 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002261 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002262 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002263 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2264
2265tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2266 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2267 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002268 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2269 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002270
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022713.3. Debugging
2272--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002273
Willy Tarreau1b857852020-02-25 11:27:22 +01002274debug (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002275 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2276 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2277 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2278 system startup.
2279
2280quiet
2281 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2282 line argument "-q".
2283
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002284zero-warning
2285 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2286 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2287 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2288 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2289 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2290 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2291
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002292
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010022933.4. Userlists
2294--------------
2295It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2296http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2297it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2298
2299userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002300 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002301 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2302
2303group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002304 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002305 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2306 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2307
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002308user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2309 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002310 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2311 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002312 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2313 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2314 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2315 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002316
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002317 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2318 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2319 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2320 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2321 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2322 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2323 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2324 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2325 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002326
2327 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002328 userlist L1
2329 group G1 users tiger,scott
2330 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002331
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002332 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2333 user scott insecure-password elgato
2334 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002335
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002336 userlist L2
2337 group G1
2338 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002339
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002340 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2341 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2342 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002343
2344 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002345
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002346
23473.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002348----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002349It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2350several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2351instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2352values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2353automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2354In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2355using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2356tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2357reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2358Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2359that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2360each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002361
2362peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002363 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002364 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2365
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002366bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2367 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2368 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2369
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002370disabled
2371 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2372 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2373 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2374
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002375default-bind [param*]
2376 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2377
2378default-server [param*]
2379 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2380
2381 Arguments:
2382 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2383 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2384 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2385 details.
2386
2387
2388 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2389
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002390enable
2391 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2392
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002393log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2394 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2395 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2396 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2397 more details.
2398
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002399peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002400 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2401 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002402 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
2403 haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
2404 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
2405 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
2406 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002407
2408 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2409 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2410
2411 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002412 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
2413 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
2414 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002415
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002416 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2417 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002418
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002419 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2420 "server" keyword explanation below).
2421
2422server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002423 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002424 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2425 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2426 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2427 of this "peers" section).
2428 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2429
2430
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002431 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002432 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002433 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002434 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2435 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2436 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002437
2438 backend mybackend
2439 mode tcp
2440 balance roundrobin
2441 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2442 stick on src
2443
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002444 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2445 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002446
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002447 Example:
2448 peers mypeers
2449 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2450 default-server ssl verify none
2451 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2452 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002453
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002454
2455table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2456 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2457
2458 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2459 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002460 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002461 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2462 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2463 "stick-table" keyword).
2464
2465 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2466 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2467 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2468 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2469 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2470 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2471 of the stick-table name as follows:
2472
2473 peers mypeers
2474 peer A ...
2475 peer B ...
2476 table t1 ...
2477
2478 frontend fe1
2479 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2480
2481 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2482 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2483
2484 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2485 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2486 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2487 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2488 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2489 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2490 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2491
2492 peers mypeers
2493 peer A ...
2494 peer B ...
2495 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2496
2497 backend t1
2498 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2499
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002500 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002501 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2502 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2503
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090025043.6. Mailers
2505------------
2506It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2507If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2508in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2509
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002510mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002511 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2512 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2513
2514mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2515 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2516
2517 Example:
2518 mailers mymailers
2519 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2520 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2521
2522 backend mybackend
2523 mode tcp
2524 balance roundrobin
2525
2526 email-alert mailers mymailers
2527 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2528 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2529
2530 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2531 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2532
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002533timeout mail <time>
2534 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2535 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2536 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2537 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2538
2539 Example:
2540 mailers mymailers
2541 timeout mail 20s
2542 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002543
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020025443.7. Programs
2545-------------
2546In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2547master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2548managed the same way as the workers.
2549
2550During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2551sequence as a worker:
2552
2553 - the master is re-executed
2554 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2555 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2556 instance of the program
2557
2558During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2559
2560program <name>
2561 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2562 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2563 the management guide).
2564
2565command <command> [arguments*]
2566 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2567 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2568 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2569 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2570
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002571user <user name>
2572 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2573 See also "group".
2574
2575group <group name>
2576 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2577 See also "user".
2578
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002579option start-on-reload
2580no option start-on-reload
2581 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2582 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2583 program section.
2584
2585
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010025863.8. HTTP-errors
2587----------------
2588
2589It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2590imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2591several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2592
2593http-errors <name>
2594 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2595 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2596
2597errorfile <code> <file>
2598 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2599
2600 Arguments :
2601 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02002602 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
2603 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002604
2605 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2606 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2607 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2608 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2609 before any chroot is performed.
2610
2611 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
2612
2613 Example:
2614 http-errors website-1
2615 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
2616 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
2617 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2618
2619 http-errors website-2
2620 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
2621 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
2622 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2623
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020026243.9. Rings
2625----------
2626
2627It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
2628servers or traces.
2629
2630ring <ringname>
2631 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
2632
2633description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002634 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002635 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
2636
2637format <format>
2638 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
2639
2640 Arguments:
2641 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
2642 one of the following :
2643
2644 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
2645 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
2646 designed to be used with a local log server.
2647
2648 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
2649 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2650 used in containers or during development, where the severity
2651 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
2652 is the default.
2653
2654 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
2655 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
2656
2657 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
2658 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
2659
2660 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2661 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
2662 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
2663 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
2664 logger consumes.
2665
2666 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2667 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
2668 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2669 used with a local log server.
2670
2671maxlen <length>
2672 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
2673 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
2674 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
2675
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002676server <name> <address> [param*]
2677 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
2678 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
2679 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
2680 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
2681 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
2682 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
2683 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
2684 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
2685 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02002686 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
2687 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002688
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002689size <size>
2690 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
2691 set to BUFSIZE.
2692
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002693timeout connect <timeout>
2694 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2695
2696 Arguments :
2697 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
2698 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2699 as explained at the top of this document.
2700
2701timeout server <timeout>
2702 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
2703
2704 Arguments :
2705 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
2706 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2707 as explained at the top of this document.
2708
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002709 Example:
2710 global
2711 log ring@myring local7
2712
2713 ring myring
2714 description "My local buffer"
2715 format rfc3164
2716 maxlen 1200
2717 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002718 timeout connect 5s
2719 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02002720 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002721
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002722
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020027234. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002724----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002725
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002726Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002727 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002728 - frontend <name>
2729 - backend <name>
2730 - listen <name>
2731
2732A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2733its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2734section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002735section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002736
2737A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2738connections.
2739
2740A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2741to forward incoming connections.
2742
2743A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2744parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2745
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002746All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2747'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2748case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2749
2750Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2751logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2752proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2753However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2754name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2755
2756Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2757and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002758bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002759protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2760modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2761arbitrary criteria.
2762
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002763In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2764a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002765the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002766
2767 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2768 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2769 between responses and new requests.
2770
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002771 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2772 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2773 client-facing connection remains open.
2774
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002775 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2776 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002777
2778The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2779frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2780following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002781weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002782
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002783 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002784
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002785 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2786 ----+-----+-----+----
2787 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2788 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002789 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2790 ----+-----+-----+----
2791 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002792
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002793
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002794
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020027954.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2796--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002797
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002798The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2799limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2800they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2801limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002802marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002803option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002804and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2805with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2806specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002807
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002808
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002809 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2810------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2811acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002812backlog X X X -
2813balance X - X X
2814bind - X X -
2815bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002816capture cookie - X X -
2817capture request header - X X -
2818capture response header - X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002819compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002820cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002821declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002822default-server X - X X
2823default_backend X X X -
2824description - X X X
2825disabled X X X X
2826dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002827email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002828email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002829email-alert mailers X X X X
2830email-alert myhostname X X X X
2831email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002832enabled X X X X
2833errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002834errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002835errorloc X X X X
2836errorloc302 X X X X
2837-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2838errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002839force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002840filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002841fullconn X - X X
2842grace X X X X
2843hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01002844http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02002845http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002846http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002847http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002848http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02002849http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002850http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002851http-check set-var X - X X
2852http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02002853http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002854http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002855http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002856http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002857http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002858id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002859ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002860load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002861log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002862log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002863log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002864log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002865max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002866maxconn X X X -
2867mode X X X X
2868monitor fail - X X -
2869monitor-net X X X -
2870monitor-uri X X X -
2871option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2872option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2873option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2874option allbackups (*) X - X X
2875option checkcache (*) X - X X
2876option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2877option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02002878option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002879option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2880option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002881-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2882option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002883option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2884option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002885option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002886option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002887option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002888option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002889option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002890option http-server-close (*) X X X X
2891option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2892option httpchk X - X X
2893option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002894option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002895option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002896option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002897option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002898option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002899option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2900option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2901option logasap (*) X X X -
2902option mysql-check X - X X
2903option nolinger (*) X X X X
2904option originalto X X X X
2905option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002906option pgsql-check X - X X
2907option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002908option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002909option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002910option smtpchk X - X X
2911option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2912option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2913option splice-request (*) X X X X
2914option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002915option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002916option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2917option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2918-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002919option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002920option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2921option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2922option tcpka X X X X
2923option tcplog X X X X
2924option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002925external-check command X - X X
2926external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002927persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2928rate-limit sessions X X X -
2929redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002930-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002931retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002932retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002933server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002934server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002935server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002936source X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002937stats admin - X X X
2938stats auth X X X X
2939stats enable X X X X
2940stats hide-version X X X X
2941stats http-request - X X X
2942stats realm X X X X
2943stats refresh X X X X
2944stats scope X X X X
2945stats show-desc X X X X
2946stats show-legends X X X X
2947stats show-node X X X X
2948stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002949-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2950stick match - - X X
2951stick on - - X X
2952stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002953stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002954stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02002955tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02002956tcp-check connect X - X X
2957tcp-check expect X - X X
2958tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02002959tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02002960tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02002961tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02002962tcp-check set-var X - X X
2963tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002964tcp-request connection - X X -
2965tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002966tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002967tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002968tcp-response content - - X X
2969tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002970timeout check X - X X
2971timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002972timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002973timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002974timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2975timeout http-request X X X X
2976timeout queue X - X X
2977timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002978timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002979timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002980timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002981transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002982unique-id-format X X X -
2983unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002984use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002985use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002986use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002987------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2988 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002989
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002990
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020029914.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2992---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002993
2994This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2995
2996
2997acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2998 Declare or complete an access list.
2999 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3000 no | yes | yes | yes
3001 Example:
3002 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3003 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3004 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3005
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003006 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003007
3008
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003009backlog <conns>
3010 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3011 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3012 yes | yes | yes | no
3013 Arguments :
3014 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3015 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003016 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003017
3018 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3019 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3020 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3021 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3022 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3023 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3024 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3025 backlog parameter.
3026
3027 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3028 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3029 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3030
3031 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3032
3033
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003034balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003035balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003036 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3038 yes | no | yes | yes
3039 Arguments :
3040 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3041 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3042 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3043 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3044
3045 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3046 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3047 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3048 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003049 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003050 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003051 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3052 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3053 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3054 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3055 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3056 it, so that you don't worry.
3057
3058 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3059 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3060 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3061 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3062 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3063 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3064 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3065 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003066
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003067 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3068 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3069 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3070 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3071 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3072 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3073 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
3074 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
3075
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003076 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003077 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003078 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3079 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003080 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003081 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3082 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3083 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3084 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3085 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003086 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3087 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3088 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3089 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3090 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3091 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003092
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003093 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3094 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3095 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3096 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3097 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3098 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3099 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3100 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003101 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003102 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003103 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3104 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3105 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003106
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003107 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3108 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3109 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3110 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3111 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3112 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3113 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3114 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3115 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3116 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3117 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3118 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003119
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003120 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003121 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3122 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3123 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3124 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3125 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3126 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3127 URIs start with a leading "/".
3128
3129 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3130 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3131 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3132 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3133
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003134 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003135 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3136
3137 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003138 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3139 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003140 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3141 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3142 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3143 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003144 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003145 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3146 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003147
3148 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3149 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3150 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3151 server will receive the request.
3152
3153 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3154 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3155 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3156 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3157 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003158 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3159 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3160 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003161
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003162 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3163 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3164 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3165 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3166 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003167
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003168 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003169 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3170 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3171 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3172
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003173 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3174 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3175 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3176
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003177 random
3178 random(<draws>)
3179 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003180 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3181 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3182 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3183 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003184 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3185 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3186 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3187 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3188 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3189 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3190 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3191 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3192 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3193 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3194 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3195 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3196 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3197 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3198 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3199 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3200 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3201 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3202 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3203 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003204
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003205 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003206 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003207 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3208 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3209 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3210 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3211 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3212 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003213 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003214 used instead.
3215
3216 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3217 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3218 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3219 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3220
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003221 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3222 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3223 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3224
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003225 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003226
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003227 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003228 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3229 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003230
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003231 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3232 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3233 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003234
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003235 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003236 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003237 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3238 NTLM relies on.
3239
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003240 Examples :
3241 balance roundrobin
3242 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003243 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003244 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3245 balance hdr(host)
3246 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003247
3248 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3249 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3250
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003251 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003252 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3253 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3254 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003255 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003256
3257 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3258 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3259 defaults to 16 kB.
3260
3261 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3262 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3263
3264 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3265 Round Robin.
3266
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003267 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003268 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3269 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3270 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3271
3272 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3273
3274 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003275 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003276 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3277 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3278 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003279
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003280 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003281
3282
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003283bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3284bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003285 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3286 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3287 no | yes | yes | no
3288 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003289 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3290 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3291 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3292 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003293 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003294 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3295 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3296 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3297 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3298 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3299 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
3300 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003301 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3302 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3303 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3304 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3305 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3306 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3307 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003308 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3309 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3310 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003311 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3312 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3313 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3314 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003315 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3316 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3317 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003318
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003319 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3320 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003321 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3322 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3323 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003324 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3325 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3326 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3327 the range.
3328
3329 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3330 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3331 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3332 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3333 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3334 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3335 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003336 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003337 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003338
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003339 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003340 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003341 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3342 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3343 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3344 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3345 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3346 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3347
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003348 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3349 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3350 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3351 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003352
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003353 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3354 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3355 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3356 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3357 in a frontend.
3358
3359 Example :
3360 listen http_proxy
3361 bind :80,:443
3362 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003363 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003364
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003365 listen http_https_proxy
3366 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003367 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003368
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003369 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3370 bind ipv6@:80
3371 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3372 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3373
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003374 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003375 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003376
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003377 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3378 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3379 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3380 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3381 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3382
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003383 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003384 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003385
3386
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003387bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003388 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3389 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3390 yes | yes | yes | yes
3391 Arguments :
3392 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3393 may be used to override a default value.
3394
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003395 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003396 option may be combined with other numbers.
3397
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003398 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003399 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3400 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3401 missing from all processes.
3402
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003403 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003404 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003405 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3406 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3407 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3408 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3409 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003410 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003411
3412 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3413 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3414 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3415 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3416 and 'even' instances.
3417
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003418 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3419 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3420 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3421 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003422
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003423 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3424 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3425
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003426 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3427 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3428 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3429
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003430 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3431 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3432
3433 Example :
3434 listen app_ip1
3435 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003436 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003437
3438 listen app_ip2
3439 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003440 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003441
3442 listen management
3443 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003444 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003445
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003446 listen management
3447 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3448 bind-process 1-4
3449
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003450 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003451
3452
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003453capture cookie <name> len <length>
3454 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3455 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3456 no | yes | yes | no
3457 Arguments :
3458 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3459 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3460 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3461 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003462 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003463
3464 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3465 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3466 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3467 right if it exceeds <length>.
3468
3469 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3470 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3471 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3472 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3473
3474 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3475 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3476 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3477
3478 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3479 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3480 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003481 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3482 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3483 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003484
3485 Example:
3486 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3487
3488 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003489 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003490
3491
3492capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003493 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3495 no | yes | yes | no
3496 Arguments :
3497 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003498 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003499 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3500 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3501 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3502
3503 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3504 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3505 it exceeds <length>.
3506
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003507 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003508 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3509 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003510 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3511 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3512 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3513 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003514 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003515 environments to find where the request came from.
3516
3517 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3518 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3519 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3520 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003521
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003522 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3523 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3524 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3525 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3526 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003527
3528 Example:
3529 capture request header Host len 15
3530 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003531 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003532
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003533 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003534 about logging.
3535
3536
3537capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003538 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003539 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3540 no | yes | yes | no
3541 Arguments :
3542 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003543 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003544 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3545 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3546 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3547
3548 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3549 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3550 it exceeds <length>.
3551
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003552 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003553 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3554 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3555 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003556 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3557 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3558 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3559 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003560
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003561 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3562 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3563 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3564 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3565 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003566
3567 Example:
3568 capture response header Content-length len 9
3569 capture response header Location len 15
3570
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003571 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003572 about logging.
3573
3574
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003575compression algo <algorithm> ...
3576compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003577compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003578 Enable HTTP compression.
3579 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3580 yes | yes | yes | yes
3581 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003582 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3583 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3584 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3585
3586 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003587 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3588 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3589 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003590
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003591 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003592 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003593
3594 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3595 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3596 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3597 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3598 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003599 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003600
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003601 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3602 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3603 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3604 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3605 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3606 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3607 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003608 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003609
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003610 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003611 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003612 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3613 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3614 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3615 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3616 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003617
3618 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3619 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3620 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3621 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3622 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003623 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3624 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3625 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3626 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3627 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003628 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3629 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003630
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003631 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003632 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3633 "Accept-Encoding" header
3634 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003635 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003636 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3637 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3638 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3639 "multipart"
3640 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3641 header
3642 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3643 and later
3644 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3645 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003646 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003647
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003648 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003649
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003650 Examples :
3651 compression algo gzip
3652 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003653
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003654
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003655cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003656 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3657 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003658 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003659 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3660 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3661 yes | no | yes | yes
3662 Arguments :
3663 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3664 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3665 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3666 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3667 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3668 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003669 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003670 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3671 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3672
3673 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3674 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3675 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3676 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3677 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3678 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003679 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3680 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003681 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003682 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3683 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003684
3685 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003686 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003687
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003688 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003689 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003690 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003691 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003692 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3693 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3694 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3695 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3696 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3697 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3698 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003699
3700 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3701 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3702 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3703 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3704 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3705 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3706 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3707 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3708 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003709 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003710 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3711 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3712 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003713
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003714 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3715 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3716 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003717 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3718 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3719 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3720 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003721 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3722 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3723 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003724
3725 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3726 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3727 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3728 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3729 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3730 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3731 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3732 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3733 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3734
3735 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3736 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3737 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3738 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3739 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3740 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3741 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3742 persistence cookie in the cache.
3743 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3744
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003745 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3746 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3747 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3748 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3749 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003750 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003751 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3752 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3753 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3754 they logout.
3755
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003756 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3757 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3758 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3759 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3760
3761 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3762 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3763 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3764 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3765 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3766 this attribute.
3767
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003768 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003769 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003770 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3771 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3772 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3773 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3774 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3775 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003776
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003777 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3778 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3779 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3780 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3781 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3782 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3783 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3784 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003785 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003786 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3787 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3788 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3789 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3790 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3791 the site.
3792
3793 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3794 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3795 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3796 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3797 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3798 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3799 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3800 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3801 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3802 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3803 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3804 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3805 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003806 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003807 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3808 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3809
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003810 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3811 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3812 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3813 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3814 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3815 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3816
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003817 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
3818 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
3819 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
3820 repeated.
3821
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003822 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3823 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3824 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3825 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003826
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003827 Examples :
3828 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3829 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3830 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003831 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003832
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003833 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003834
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003835
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003836declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3837 Declares a capture slot.
3838 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3839 no | yes | yes | no
3840 Arguments:
3841 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3842
3843 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3844 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3845 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3846 for use in the response.
3847
3848 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003849 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003850 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3851
3852
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003853default-server [param*]
3854 Change default options for a server in a backend
3855 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3856 yes | no | yes | yes
3857 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003858 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3859 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3860 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3861 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003862
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003863 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003864 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3865
3866 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003867
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003868
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003869default_backend <backend>
3870 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3871 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3872 yes | yes | yes | no
3873 Arguments :
3874 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3875
3876 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3877 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3878 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3879 will catch all undetermined requests.
3880
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003881 Example :
3882
3883 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3884 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3885 default_backend dynamic
3886
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003887 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003888
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003889
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003890description <string>
3891 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3892 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3893 no | yes | yes | yes
3894 Arguments : string
3895
3896 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3897 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3898 it describes.
3899 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3900
3901
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003902disabled
3903 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3904 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3905 yes | yes | yes | yes
3906 Arguments : none
3907
3908 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3909 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3910 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3911 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3912 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3913 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3914 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3915
3916 See also : "enabled"
3917
3918
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003919dispatch <address>:<port>
3920 Set a default server address
3921 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3922 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003923 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003924
3925 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3926 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3927 during start-up.
3928
3929 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3930 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3931 possible with normal servers.
3932
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003933 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003934 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3935 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3936 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3937 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3938
3939 See also : "server"
3940
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003941
3942dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3943 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3944 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3945 yes | no | yes | yes
3946 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3947
3948 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003949 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003950 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3951 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003952 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003953 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003954
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003955enabled
3956 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3957 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3958 yes | yes | yes | yes
3959 Arguments : none
3960
3961 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3962 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3963
3964 See also : "disabled"
3965
3966
3967errorfile <code> <file>
3968 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3969 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3970 yes | yes | yes | yes
3971 Arguments :
3972 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003973 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02003974 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003975
3976 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003977 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003978 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003979 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3980 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003981
3982 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3983 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3984 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3985
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003986 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3987
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02003988 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
3989 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
3990 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
3991 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
3992 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
3993 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
3994 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
3995 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
3996 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003997
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003998 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3999 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4000 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004001 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004002 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4003
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004004 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004005
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004006 Example :
4007 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004008 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004009 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4010 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4011
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004012
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004013errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4014 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4015 section.
4016 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4017 yes | yes | yes | yes
4018 Arguments :
4019 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4020
4021 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004022 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004023 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004024
4025 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4026 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4027 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4028 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4029 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004030 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004031 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4032
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004033 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4034 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004035
4036 Example :
4037 errorfiles generic
4038 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4039
4040
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004041errorloc <code> <url>
4042errorloc302 <code> <url>
4043 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4044 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4045 yes | yes | yes | yes
4046 Arguments :
4047 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004048 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004049 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004050
4051 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4052 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4053 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4054 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004055 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004056
4057 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4058 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4059 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4060
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004061 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4062
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004063 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4064 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4065 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4066 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004067 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004068 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4069 request.
4070
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004071 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004072
4073
4074errorloc303 <code> <url>
4075 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4076 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4077 yes | yes | yes | yes
4078 Arguments :
4079 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004080 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004081 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004082
4083 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4084 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4085 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4086 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004087 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004088
4089 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4090 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4091 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4092
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004093 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4094
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004095 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4096 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4097 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4098 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004099 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004100
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004101 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004102
4103
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004104email-alert from <emailaddr>
4105 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004106 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004107 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4108 yes | yes | yes | yes
4109
4110 Arguments :
4111
4112 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4113
4114 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4115 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4116
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004117 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004118 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4119 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004120
4121
4122email-alert level <level>
4123 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4124 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4125 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4126 yes | yes | yes | yes
4127
4128 Arguments :
4129
4130 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4131 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4132 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4133
4134 By default level is alert
4135
4136 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4137 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4138 for the proxy.
4139
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004140 Alerts are sent when :
4141
4142 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4143 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4144 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4145 is notice or lower
4146 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4147 and a health check status update occurs
4148
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004149 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4150 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004151 section 3.6 about mailers.
4152
4153
4154email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4155 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4156 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4157 yes | yes | yes | yes
4158
4159 Arguments :
4160
4161 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4162
4163 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4164 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4165
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004166 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4167 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004168
4169
4170email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4171 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4172 mailers.
4173 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4174 yes | yes | yes | yes
4175
4176 Arguments :
4177
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004178 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004179
4180 By default the systems hostname is used.
4181
4182 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4183 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4184 for the proxy.
4185
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004186 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4187 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004188
4189
4190email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004191 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004192 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4193 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4194 yes | yes | yes | yes
4195
4196 Arguments :
4197
4198 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4199
4200 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4201 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4202
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004203 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004204 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4205
4206
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004207force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4208 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4209 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004210 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004211
4212 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4213 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4214 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4215 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4216 marked down for maintenance operations.
4217
4218 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4219 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4220 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4221 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4222 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4223 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4224 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4225 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4226 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4227
4228 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4229 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4230 is used.
4231
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004232 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004233 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004234
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004235
4236filter <name> [param*]
4237 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4238 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4239 no | yes | yes | yes
4240 Arguments :
4241 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4242 referenced in section 9.
4243
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004244 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004245 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004246 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4247 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004248
4249 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4250 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4251
4252 Example:
4253 listen
4254 bind *:80
4255
4256 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4257 filter compression
4258 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4259
4260 compression algo gzip
4261 compression offload
4262
4263 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4264
4265 See also : section 9.
4266
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004267
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004268fullconn <conns>
4269 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4270 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4271 yes | no | yes | yes
4272 Arguments :
4273 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4274 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4275
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004276 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004277 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004278 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004279 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4280 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4281 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4282 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4283 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004284 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004285
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004286 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4287 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004288 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4289 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4290 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004291
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004292 Example :
4293 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4294 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4295 # connections.
4296 backend dynamic
4297 fullconn 10000
4298 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4299 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4300
4301 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4302
4303
4304grace <time>
4305 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4306 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004307 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004308 Arguments :
4309 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4310 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4311 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4312
4313 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4314 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004315 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004316 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4317
4318 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4319 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4320 simplify it.
4321
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004322
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004323hash-balance-factor <factor>
4324 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4325 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4326 yes | no | no | yes
4327 Arguments :
4328 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4329 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004330 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004331
4332 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4333 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4334 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4335 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4336 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4337 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4338 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4339
4340 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4341 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4342 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4343 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4344 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4345
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004346 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4347 consistent hashing mechanism.
4348
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004349 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4350
4351
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004352hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004353 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4354 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4355 yes | no | yes | yes
4356 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004357 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4358 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004359
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004360 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4361 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4362 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4363 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4364 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4365 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4366 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4367 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4368 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4369 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004370
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004371 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4372 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4373 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4374 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4375 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4376 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4377 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4378 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4379 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4380 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4381 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4382 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4383 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004384 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4385 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004386
4387 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4388
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004389 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004390 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4391 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4392 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004393 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4394 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4395 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004396
4397 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4398 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004399 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4400 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4401 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4402 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4403
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004404 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4405 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4406 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4407 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4408 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4409 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4410 parameter.
4411
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004412 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4413 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4414 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4415 used on strings.
4416
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004417 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4418
4419 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4420 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4421 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4422 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4423 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4424 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4425 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4426 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4427 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4428 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4429 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4430 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004431
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004432 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4433 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4434 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004435
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004436 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004437
4438
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004439http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4440 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
4441 ones).
4442
4443 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4444 no | yes | yes | yes
4445
4446 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
4447 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
4448 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4449 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4450 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4451 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4452
4453 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
4454 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
4455 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
4456
4457 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4458 below.
4459
4460 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
4461 instance.
4462
4463 Example:
4464 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
4465 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
4466 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
4467
4468http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4469
4470 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4471 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4472 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4473 example, or to pass some internal information.
4474 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4475 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4476 the resulting header from a previous rule.
4477
4478http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4479
4480 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4481 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
4482
4483http-after-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4484
4485 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
4486
4487http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4488 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4489
4490 This works like "http-response replace-header".
4491
4492 Example:
4493 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4494
4495 # applied to:
4496 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4497
4498 # outputs:
4499 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4500
4501 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4502
4503http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4504 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4505
4506 This works like "http-response replace-value".
4507
4508 Example:
4509 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4510
4511 # applied to:
4512 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4513
4514 # outputs:
4515 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4516
4517http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4518
4519 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4520 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4521 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
4522
4523http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4524 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4525
4526 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4527 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4528 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4529 fallback.
4530
4531 Example:
4532 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4533 http-response set-status 431
4534 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4535 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
4536
4537http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4538
4539 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4540 inline.
4541
4542 Arguments:
4543 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4544 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4545 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4546 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4547 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4548 (request and response)
4549 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4550 processing
4551 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4552 processing
4553 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4554 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
4555 and '_'.
4556
4557 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4558 followed by some converters.
4559
4560 Example:
4561 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4562
4563http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
4564
4565 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
4566 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
4567 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
4568 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
4569 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004570 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004571 processing.
4572
4573 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
4574 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004575 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004576 rules evaluation.
4577
4578http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4579
4580 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
4581 details about <var-name>.
4582
4583 Example:
4584 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4585
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004586
4587http-check comment <string>
4588 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
4589 it fails.
4590 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4591 yes | no | yes | yes
4592
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004593 Arguments :
4594 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
4595 rule fails.
4596
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004597 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
4598 user-friendly error reporting.
4599
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004600 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004601 "http-check expect".
4602
4603
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004604http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
4605 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02004606 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004607 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
4608 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4609 yes | no | yes | yes
4610
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004611 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004612 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4613
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004614 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004615 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004616
4617 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
4618 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
4619 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
4620 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
4621
4622 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
4623
4624 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
4625
4626 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
4627
4628 ssl opens a ciphered connection
4629
4630 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
4631
4632 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
4633 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
4634 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
4635 is used.
4636
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02004637 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
4638 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
4639 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
4640 haproxy -vv.
4641
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004642 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
4643
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004644 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
4645 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
4646 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
4647 different ports or with different servers.
4648
4649 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
4650 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
4651 the port with a "http-check connect".
4652
4653 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
4654 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
4655 do.
4656
4657 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
4658 unset-var or comment rules.
4659
4660 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004661 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
4662 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
4663 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
4664 option httpchk
4665
4666 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02004667 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004668 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004669 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02004670 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004671 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004672
4673 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
4674
4675 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004676
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004677
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004678http-check disable-on-404
4679 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4680 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004681 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004682 Arguments : none
4683
4684 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4685 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4686 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4687 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4688 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4689 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4690 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4691 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004692 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4693 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4694 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4695
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004696 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004697
4698
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004699http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004700 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
4701 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
4702 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004703 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004704 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004705 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004706
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004707 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004708 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4709
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004710 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
4711 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
4712 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
4713 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
4714 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
4715 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
4716 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
4717 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
4718 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
4719 result is always conclusive.
4720
4721 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4722 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
4723 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004724 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
4725 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
4726 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, for
4727 example 404 with disable-on-404
4728 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
4729 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
4730 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004731
4732 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4733 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004734 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported :
4735 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
4736 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
4737 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
4738 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
4739 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004740
4741 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4742 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004743 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
4744 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
4745 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
4746 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004747 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
4748
4749 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
4750 informational message reported in logs if the expect
4751 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
4752 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
4753
4754 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
4755 informational message reported in logs if an error
4756 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
4757 log-format string.
4758
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004759 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004760 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
4761 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004762 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4763 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4764 details on the supported keywords.
4765
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004766 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
4767 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
4768 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
4769 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004770
4771 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4772 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4773 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4774 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4775 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4776
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004777 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
4778 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
4779 codes. A health check response will be considered as
4780 valid if the response's status code matches any status
4781 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
4782 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4783 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004784
4785 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004786 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004787 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4788 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4789 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4790 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4791
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004792 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
4793 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004794 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
4795 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
4796 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
4797 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
4798 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
4799 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
4800 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
4801 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004802 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
4803 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
4804 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
4805 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
4806 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
4807 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
4808 insensitive on the header names.
4809
4810 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
4811 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
4812 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
4813 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
4814 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
4815 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004816
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004817 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004818 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004819 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4820 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4821 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4822 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4823 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004824 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004825 trace).
4826
4827 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004828 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004829 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4830 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4831 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4832 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4833 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004834 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004835
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02004836 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
4837 A health check response will be considered valid if the
4838 response's body contains the string resulting of the
4839 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
4840 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4841 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
4842
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004843 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4844 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4845 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4846 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4847 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4848 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4849 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4850 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4851
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004852 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
4853 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
4854 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
4855 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
4856 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004857
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004858 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4859 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4860
4861 Examples :
4862 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004863 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004864
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004865 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
4866 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
4867
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004868 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004869 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004870
4871 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004872 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004873
4874 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004875 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004876
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004877 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004878 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004879
4880
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02004881http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02004882 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
4883 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004884 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
4885 health checks.
4886 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4887 yes | no | yes | yes
4888 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004889 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4890
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004891 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
4892 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
4893 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
4894 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
4895 to invent non-standard ones.
4896
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02004897 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
4898 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
4899 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
4900 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4901
4902 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
4903 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
4904 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4905 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004906
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02004907 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004908 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004909 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004910 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
4911 to add it.
4912
4913 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4914 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
4915 to the log-format rules.
4916
4917 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
4918 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
4919 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004920
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02004921 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
4922 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
4923 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
4924 request.
4925
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004926 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
4927 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
4928 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02004929 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
4930 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
4931 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
4932 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004933 deprecated. Note also the "Connection: close" header is still added if a
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004934 "http-check expect" directive is defined independently of this directive, just
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004935 like the state header if the directive "http-check send-state" is defined.
4936
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004937 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4938 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02004939 header should not be present in the request provided by "http-check send". If
4940 so, it will be ignored.
4941
4942 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
4943 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
4944 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
4945 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
4946 configured request authority.
4947
4948 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
4949 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004950
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004951 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004952
4953
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004954http-check send-state
4955 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4956 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4957 yes | no | yes | yes
4958 Arguments : none
4959
4960 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4961 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4962 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4963 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4964 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4965
4966 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4967 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4968 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4969 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4970 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004971 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4972 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4973 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4974
4975 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4976 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4977 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4978
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004979 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4980 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4981 checked in multiple backends.
4982
4983 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4984 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4985
4986 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4987 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4988 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4989 one fails.
4990
4991 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4992 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4993 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4994
4995 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4996 server's queue.
4997
4998 Example of a header received by the application server :
4999 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5000 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5001
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005002 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5003 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005004
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005005
5006http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005007 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005008 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5009 yes | no | yes | yes
5010
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005011 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005012 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5013 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5014 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5015 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5016 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5017 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5018 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5019 and '-'.
5020
5021 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5022
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005023 Examples :
5024 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005025
5026
5027http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005028 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005029 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5030 yes | no | yes | yes
5031
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005032 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005033 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5034 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5035 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5036 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5037 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5038 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5039 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5040 and '-'.
5041
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005042 Examples :
5043 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005044
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005045
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005046http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5047 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5048 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5049 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5050 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5051 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5052 yes | yes | yes | yes
5053 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005054 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005055 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005056 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
5057 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005058
5059 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5060 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5061 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5062 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5063
5064 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5065 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5066 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5067 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5068
5069 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5070 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5071 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5072 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5073 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5074 chroot is performed.
5075
5076 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5077 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5078 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5079 considered.
5080
5081 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5082 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5083 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5084 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5085 considered as a raw string.
5086
5087 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5088 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5089 "content-type".
5090
5091 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5092 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5093 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5094 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5095 evaluated as a log-format string.
5096
5097 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5098 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5099 argument to "content-type".
5100
5101 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5102 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5103 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5104 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5105
5106 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5107 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5108 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5109 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5110 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5111 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5112 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5113 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5114
5115 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5116 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5117 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5118
5119 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5120 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5121
5122
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005123http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005124 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5125
5126 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5127 no | yes | yes | yes
5128
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005129 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5130 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5131 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5132 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5133 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005134
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005135 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5136 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005137
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005138 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005139
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005140 Example:
5141 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5142 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5143 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005144
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005145 http-request allow if nagios
5146 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5147 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5148 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005149
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005150 Example:
5151 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5152 acl add path /addacl
5153 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005154
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005155 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005156
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005157 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5158 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005159
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005160 Example:
5161 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5162 acl setmap path /setmap
5163 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005164
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005165 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005166
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005167 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5168 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005169
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005170 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5171 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005172
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005173http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005174
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005175 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5176 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5177 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5178 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5179 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
5180 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5181 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5182 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005183
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005184http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005185
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005186 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
5187 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
5188 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
5189 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
5190 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
5191 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
5192 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
5193 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005194
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005195http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005196
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005197 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
5198 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005199
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005200
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005201http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005202
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005203 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
5204 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
5205 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
5206 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
5207 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005208
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005209 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
5210 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
5211 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
5212 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
5213 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
5214 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
5215 instead.
5216
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005217 Example:
5218 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
5219 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005220
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005221http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005222
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005223 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005224
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005225http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
5226 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005227
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005228 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
5229 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
5230 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
5231 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
5232 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
5233 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
5234 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
5235 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
5236 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005237
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005238 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
5239 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
5240 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005241 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
5242
5243 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5244 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5245 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5246 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005247
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005248http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005249
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005250 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5251 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5252 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5253 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5254 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5255 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005256
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005257http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005258
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005259 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005260
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005261http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005262
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005263 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5264 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5265 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5266 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5267 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5268 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005269
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005270http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5271http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
5272 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5273 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5274 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5275 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005276
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005277 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
5278 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
5279 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005280 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005281 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
5282 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
5283 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005284 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005285 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005286
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02005287http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5288 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
5289 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
5290 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
5291
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01005292http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
5293
5294 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
5295 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
5296 pointed by <resolvers>.
5297 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
5298 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
5299 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
5300 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
5301 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
5302 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
5303 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
5304 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
5305 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
5306 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
5307 to 0.0.0.0.
5308
5309 Example:
5310 resolvers mydns
5311 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
5312 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
5313 timeout retry 1s
5314 hold valid 10s
5315 hold nx 3s
5316 hold other 3s
5317 hold obsolete 0s
5318 accepted_payload_size 8192
5319
5320 frontend fe
5321 bind 10.42.0.1:80
5322 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
5323 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
5324
5325 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
5326 # which mean DNS resolution error
5327 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
5328
5329 default_backend be
5330
5331 backend b_503
5332 # dummy backend used to return 503.
5333 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
5334 # 503 error page to end users
5335
5336 backend be
5337 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
5338 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
5339 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
5340 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
5341 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
5342
5343 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
5344 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
5345
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005346http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5347
5348 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
5349 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
5350 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
5351 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01005352 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
5353 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005354
5355 See RFC 8297 for more information.
5356
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005357http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005358
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005359 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
5360 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
5361 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
5362 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
5363 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005364
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005365http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005366
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005367 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
5368 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
5369 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
5370 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005371
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005372http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5373 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02005374
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005375 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005376 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
5377 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
5378 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
5379 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
5380 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02005381
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005382 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
5383 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
5384 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
5385 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
5386 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005387
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005388 Example:
5389 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
5390
5391 # applied to:
5392 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5393
5394 # outputs:
5395 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5396
5397 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005398
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005399 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
5400
5401 # applied to:
5402 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005403
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005404 # outputs:
5405 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005406
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005407http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5408 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5409
5410 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
5411 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
5412 after an optional scheme+authority. It does contain the query string if any
5413 is present. The replacement does not modify the scheme nor authority.
5414
5415 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5416 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5417 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
5418
5419 Example:
5420 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5421 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
5422
5423 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
5424 http-request replace-path ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
5425
5426 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
5427 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
5428 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
5429 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
5430
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005431http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5432 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5433
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005434 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
5435 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
5436 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
5437 against.
5438
5439 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5440 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5441 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005442
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005443 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
5444 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
5445 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
5446 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
5447 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
5448 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
5449 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
5450 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
5451 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005452 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
5453 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005454
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005455 Example:
5456 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
5457 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005458
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005459 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5460 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005461
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005462http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5463 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005464
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005465 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
5466 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
5467 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
5468 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005469
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005470 Example:
5471 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005472
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005473 # applied to:
5474 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005475
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005476 # outputs:
5477 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005478
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005479http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
5480 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5481 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005482 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005483 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5484
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005485 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005486 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
5487 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005488 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005489 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005490 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005491 are followed to create the response :
5492
5493 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
5494 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
5495 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5496 ignored.
5497
5498 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
5499 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005500 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005501 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any,
5502 is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005503
5504 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
5505 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
5506 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005507 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005508 and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005509
5510 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
5511 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
5512 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005513 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005514 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
5515 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005516
5517 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
5518 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
5519 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
5520 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
5521 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
5522 as a raw content.
5523
5524 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
5525 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
5526 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
5527 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
5528 considered as a raw string.
5529
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005530 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
5531 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
5532 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
5533 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
5534
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005535 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
5536 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005537 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005538
5539 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5540
5541 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005542 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005543 if { path /ping }
5544
5545 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
5546 if { path /favicon.ico }
5547
5548 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
5549 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
5550 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
5551
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005552http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5553http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005554
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005555 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5556 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5557 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005558
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005559http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5560 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005561
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005562 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5563 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5564 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5565 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005566
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005567http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005568
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005569 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
5570 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
5571 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
5572 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
5573 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005574
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005575 Arguments:
5576 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5577 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005578
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005579 Example:
5580 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
5581 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005582
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005583 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
5584 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005585
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005586http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005587
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005588 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
5589 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
5590 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005591
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005592 Arguments:
5593 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5594 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005595
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005596 Example:
5597 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
5598 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005599
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005600 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
5601 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
5602 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005603
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005604http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005605
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005606 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
5607 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
5608 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
5609 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
5610 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005611
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005612 Example:
5613 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
5614 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
5615 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
5616 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
5617 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
5618 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
5619 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
5620 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
5621 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005622
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005623http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005624
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005625 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5626 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5627 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5628 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
5629 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005630
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005631http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5632 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005633
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005634 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5635 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5636 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5637 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5638 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
5639 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
5640 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
5641 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
5642 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005643
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005644http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005645
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005646 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5647 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5648 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5649 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
5650 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
5651 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
5652 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005653
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005654http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005655
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005656 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
5657 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
5658 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005659
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005660http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005661
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005662 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
5663 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
5664 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
5665 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
5666 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
5667 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5668 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5669 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005670
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005671http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005672
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005673 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
5674 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
5675 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
5676 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
5677 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
5678 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005679
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005680 Example :
5681 # prepend the host name before the path
5682 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005683
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005684http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02005685
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005686 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
5687 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
5688 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5689 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
5690 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005691
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005692http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005693
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005694 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
5695 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
5696 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5697 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
5698 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
5699 values have higher priority.
5700 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
5701 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
5702 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
5703 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
5704 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005705
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005706http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005707
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005708 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
5709 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
5710 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
5711 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
5712 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
5713 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
5714 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005715
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005716 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005717
5718 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005719 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
5720 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005721
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005722http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5723 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
5724 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
5725 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005726 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
5727 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005728
5729 Arguments :
5730 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5731 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005732
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005733 See also "option forwardfor".
5734
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005735 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005736 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
5737 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
5738
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005739 # After the masking this will track connections
5740 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
5741 http-request track-sc0 src
5742
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005743 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
5744 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
5745
5746http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5747
5748 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
5749 expression.
5750
5751 Arguments:
5752 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5753 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005754
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005755 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005756 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
5757 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
5758
5759 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
5760 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
5761 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
5762
5763http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5764
5765 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5766 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
5767 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
5768 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
5769 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
5770 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
5771 information from the request.
5772
5773 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5774
5775http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5776
5777 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
5778 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
5779 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
5780 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
5781 path and the query string.
5782 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
5783
5784http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5785
5786 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5787 inline.
5788
5789 Arguments:
5790 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5791 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5792 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5793 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5794 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5795 (request and response)
5796 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5797 processing
5798 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5799 processing
5800 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5801 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
5802 and '_'.
5803
5804 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5805 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005806
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005807 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005808 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005809
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005810http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
5811 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005812
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005813 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5814 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5815 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5816 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5817 agent name must be used.
5818
5819 Arguments:
5820 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
5821
5822 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5823 configuration.
5824
5825http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5826
5827 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5828 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5829 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5830 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5831 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5832 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5833 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5834 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5835 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5836 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5837 action.
5838 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5839 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5840 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5841 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5842 you fully understand how it works.
5843
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005844http-request strict-mode { on | off }
5845
5846 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5847 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5848 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5849 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5850 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005851 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005852 processing.
5853
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01005854 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005855 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
5856 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
5857 rules evaluation.
5858
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005859http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5860http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
5861 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5862 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5863 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5864 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005865
5866 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
5867 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
5868 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005869 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
5870 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
5871 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
5872 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
5873 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
5874 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
5875 things worse by forcing haproxy and the front firewall to support insane
5876 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
5877 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
5878 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005879 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005880 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
5881 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
5882 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
5883 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5884 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005885
5886http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5887http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5888http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5889
5890 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
5891 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
5892 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
5893 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
5894 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
5895 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
5896 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
5897 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
5898 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
5899 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
5900 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
5901 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
5902
5903 Arguments :
5904 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
5905 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
5906 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
5907 select which table entry to update the counters.
5908
5909 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
5910 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
5911 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
5912 that table until the session ends.
5913
5914 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
5915 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
5916 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
5917 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
5918 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
5919 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
5920 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
5921 useful information.
5922
5923 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
5924 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
5925 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
5926 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
5927 checks that make use of it.
5928
5929http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5930
5931 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005932
5933 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005934 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005935
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01005936http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5937
5938 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
5939 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
5940 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
5941 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
5942 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
5943 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5944
5945 Arguments :
5946 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
5947
5948 Example:
5949 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
5950
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005951http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005952
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005953 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
5954 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
5955 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005956
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005957
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005958http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005959 Access control for Layer 7 responses
5960
5961 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5962 no | yes | yes | yes
5963
5964 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5965 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5966 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5967 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5968 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5969 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5970
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005971 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5972 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005973
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005974 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005975
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005976 Example:
5977 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005978
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005979 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005980
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005981 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
5982 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005983
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005984 Example:
5985 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005986
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005987 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005988
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005989 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
5990 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005991
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005992 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5993 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005994
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005995http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005996
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005997 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5998 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5999 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6000 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6001 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6002 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6003 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6004 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006005
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006006http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006007
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006008 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
6009 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
6010 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
6011 example, or to pass some internal information.
6012 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
6013 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
6014 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006015
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006016http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006017
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006018 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
6019 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006020
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006021http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006022
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006023 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006024
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006025http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006026
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006027 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
6028 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
6029 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
6030 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
6031 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
6032 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
6033 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006034
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006035 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
6036 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
6037 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
6038 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
6039 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006040
6041 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6042 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6043 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6044 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006045
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006046http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006047
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006048 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6049 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6050 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6051 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6052 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6053 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006054
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006055http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006056
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006057 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006058
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006059http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006060
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006061 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6062 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6063 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6064 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6065 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6066 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006067
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006068http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6069http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6070 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6071 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6072 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6073 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006074
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006075 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
6076 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6077 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006078 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006079 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
6080 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
6081 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01006082 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006083 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006084
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006085http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006086
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006087 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
6088 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
6089 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
6090 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
6091 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
6092 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006093
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006094http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6095 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006096
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006097 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
6098 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006099
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006100 Example:
6101 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02006102
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006103 # applied to:
6104 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006105
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006106 # outputs:
6107 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006108
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006109 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006110
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006111http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6112 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006113
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01006114 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006115 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006116
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006117 Example:
6118 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006119
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006120 # applied to:
6121 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006122
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006123 # outputs:
6124 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006125
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006126http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6127 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6128 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006129 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006130 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6131
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006132 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006133 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6134 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006135 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006136 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006137 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006138 are followed to create the response :
6139
6140 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6141 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6142 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6143 ignored.
6144
6145 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6146 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006147 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006148 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any,
6149 is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006150
6151 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6152 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6153 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006154 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006155 and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006156
6157 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6158 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6159 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006160 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006161 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
6162 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006163
6164 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6165 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6166 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6167 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6168 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6169 as a raw content.
6170
6171 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6172 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6173 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6174 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6175 considered as a raw string.
6176
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006177 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
6178 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6179 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6180 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6181
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006182 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6183 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006184 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006185
6186 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
6187
6188 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006189 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006190 if { status eq 404 }
6191
6192 http-response return content-type text/plain \
6193 string "This is the end !" \
6194 if { status eq 500 }
6195
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006196http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6197http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08006198
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006199 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6200 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6201 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006202
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006203http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6204 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006205
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006206 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6207 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6208 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6209 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006210
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006211http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006212
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006213 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6214 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6215 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6216 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6217 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006218
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006219 Arguments:
6220 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006221
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006222 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6223 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006224
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006225http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006226
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006227 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
6228 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
6229 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006230
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006231http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6232
6233 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6234 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6235 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6236 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
6237 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
6238
6239http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6240
6241 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6242 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6243 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6244 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6245 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
6246 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6247 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6248 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
6249 be triggered by an HTTP response.
6250
6251http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6252
6253 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6254 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6255 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6256 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
6257 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
6258 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
6259 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
6260
6261http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6262
6263 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
6264 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
6265 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
6266 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
6267 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
6268 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6269 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6270 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
6271
6272http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
6273 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6274
6275 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
6276 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
6277 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
6278 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006279
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006280 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006281 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
6282 http-response set-status 431
6283 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
6284 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006285
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006286http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006287
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006288 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6289 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
6290 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
6291 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
6292 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
6293 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
6294 based on some information from the request.
6295
6296 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6297
6298http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6299
6300 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6301 inline.
6302
6303 Arguments:
6304 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6305 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6306 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6307 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6308 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6309 (request and response)
6310 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6311 processing
6312 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6313 processing
6314 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6315 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
6316 and '_'.
6317
6318 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6319 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006320
6321 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006322 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006323
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006324http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006325
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006326 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6327 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6328 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6329 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6330 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6331 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6332 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6333 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6334 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6335 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6336 action.
6337 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6338 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6339 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6340 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6341 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006342
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006343http-response strict-mode { on | off }
6344
6345 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6346 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6347 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6348 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6349 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006350 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006351 processing.
6352
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006353 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006354 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006355 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006356 rules evaluation.
6357
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006358http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6359http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6360http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006361
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006362 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
6363 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
6364 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
6365 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
6366 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
6367 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
6368
6369http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6370
6371 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
6372 about <var-name>.
6373
6374 Example:
6375 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
6376
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02006377
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006378http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
6379 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
6380
6381 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6382 yes | no | yes | yes
6383
6384 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006385 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
6386 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
6387 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006388
6389 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
6390
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006391 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
6392 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
6393 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
6394 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
6395 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
6396 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
6397 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
6398 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
6399 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
6400 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006401
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006402 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
6403 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
6404 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
6405 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
6406 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
6407 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
6408 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
6409 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006410
6411 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
6412 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
6413 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
6414 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
6415 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
6416 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
6417 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
6418 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02006419 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006420 downsides of rare connection failures.
6421
6422 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
6423 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
6424 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
6425 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
6426 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
6427 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006428 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006429 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
6430 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
6431 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
6432 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
6433 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
6434
6435 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006436 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
6437 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
6438 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006439
6440 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006441 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006442
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02006443 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
6444 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006445
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01006446 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006447
6448 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
6449 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
6450 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
6451
6452 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
6453
6454
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006455http-send-name-header [<header>]
6456 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006457 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6458 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006459 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006460 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
6461
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02006462 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
6463 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
6464 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
6465 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
6466 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
6467 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
6468 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
6469 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
6470 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
6471 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
6472 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
6473 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
6474 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
6475 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
6476 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
6477 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006478
6479 See also : "server"
6480
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006481id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006482 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
6483 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6484 no | yes | yes | yes
6485 Arguments : none
6486
6487 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
6488 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
6489 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006490
6491
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006492ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
6493 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
6494 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01006495 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006496
6497 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
6498 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
6499 and running).
6500
6501 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
6502 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
6503 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006504 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006505 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
6506
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006507 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
6508 "unless" condition is met.
6509
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006510 Example:
6511 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
6512 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
6513 ignore-persist if url_static
6514
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006515 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
6516
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006517load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
6518 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
6519 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6520 yes | no | yes | yes
6521
6522 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
6523 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
6524 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006525 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006526 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
6527 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
6528 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
6529 over the stats socket and redirect output.
6530
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006531 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006532 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02006533 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006534
6535 Arguments:
6536 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
6537 named "server-state-file".
6538
6539 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
6540 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
6541 name is used as a file name.
6542
6543 none don't load any stat for this backend
6544
6545 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01006546 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
6547 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
6548 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006549 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01006550 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006551
6552 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
6553 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
6554
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006555 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006556
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006557 global
6558 stats socket /tmp/socket
6559 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006560
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006561 defaults
6562 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006563
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006564 backend bk
6565 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
6566 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006567
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006568
6569 Then one can run :
6570
6571 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
6572
6573 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
6574
6575 1
6576 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6577 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6578 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6579
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006580 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006581
6582 global
6583 stats socket /tmp/socket
6584 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
6585
6586 defaults
6587 load-server-state-from-file local
6588
6589 backend bk
6590 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
6591 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
6592
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006593
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006594 Then one can run :
6595
6596 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
6597
6598 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
6599
6600 1
6601 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6602 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6603 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6604
6605 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
6606 "show servers state"
6607
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006608
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006609log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006610log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
6611 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006612no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006613 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
6614 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6615 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006616
6617 Prefix :
6618 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
6619 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
6620 prefix does not allow arguments.
6621
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006622 Arguments :
6623 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
6624 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
6625 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
6626 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
6627 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
6628 parameter.
6629
6630 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
6631 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
6632
6633 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
6634 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6635 standard syslog port).
6636
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01006637 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
6638 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6639 standard syslog port).
6640
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006641 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
6642 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
6643 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006644 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006645
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006646 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
6647 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
6648 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
6649 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
6650 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
6651 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
6652 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
6653 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
6654 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
6655 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
6656 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
6657 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
6658 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
6659 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
6660 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
6661 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006662 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
6663 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006664
6665 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
6666 and "fd@2", see above.
6667
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02006668 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
6669 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
6670 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
6671 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
6672 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
6673 having the logs instantly available.
6674
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006675 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
6676 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006677
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006678 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
6679 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
6680 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
6681 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
6682 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
6683 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
6684 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
6685 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
6686 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
6687 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006688 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006689
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006690 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
6691 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
6692 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
6693 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
6694 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
6695
6696 <sample_size>
6697 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
6698 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
6699 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
6700 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
6701 (see also <ranges> parameter).
6702
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01006703 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
6704 one of the following :
6705
6706 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
6707 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
6708
6709 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
6710 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
6711
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006712 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
6713 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
6714 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
6715 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
6716 systemd logger consumes.
6717
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006718 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
6719 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
6720 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
6721 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
6722
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006723 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
6724
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006725 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
6726 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
6727 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
6728
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006729 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
6730 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
6731 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
6732 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006733
6734 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
6735 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
6736 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006737 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
6738 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
6739 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
6740 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
6741 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006742
6743 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
6744
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006745 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
6746 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
6747 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006748
6749 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
6750 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
6751 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
6752 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
6753
6754 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
6755 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006756
6757 Example :
6758 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006759 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
6760 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
6761 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006762 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
6763 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006764 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006765
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006766
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006767log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006768 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
6769 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6770 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006771
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006772 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
6773 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
6774 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
6775 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
6776 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006777
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006778 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
6779 "option httplog" directives.
6780
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02006781log-format-sd <string>
6782 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
6783 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6784 yes | yes | yes | no
6785
6786 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
6787 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
6788 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
6789 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
6790 which covers the log format string in depth.
6791
6792 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
6793 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
6794
6795 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
6796 log format to "rfc5424".
6797
6798 Example :
6799 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
6800
6801
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01006802log-tag <string>
6803 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
6804 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6805 yes | yes | yes | yes
6806
6807 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
6808 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
6809 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
6810 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
6811 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
6812 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
6813 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
6814 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
6815 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006816
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006817max-keep-alive-queue <value>
6818 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
6819 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6820 yes | no | yes | yes
6821
6822 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
6823 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
6824 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
6825 servers.
6826
6827 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
6828 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
6829 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
6830 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
6831 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006832 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006833 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
6834 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
6835 picking a different server.
6836
6837 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
6838 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
6839 even if they have to be queued.
6840
6841 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
6842 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
6843
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01006844max-session-srv-conns <nb>
6845 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
6846 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
6847 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006848
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006849maxconn <conns>
6850 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
6851 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6852 yes | yes | yes | no
6853 Arguments :
6854 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
6855 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
6856 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
6857 closes.
6858
6859 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
6860 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
6861 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
6862 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01006863 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
6864 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
6865 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
6866 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006867
6868 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
6869 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
6870 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
6871
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01006872 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
6873 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02006874
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006875 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
6876
6877
6878mode { tcp|http|health }
6879 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
6880 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6881 yes | yes | yes | yes
6882 Arguments :
6883 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
6884 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
6885 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
6886 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
6887
6888 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
6889 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
6890 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
6891 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
6892 brings HAProxy most of its value.
6893
6894 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006895 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
6896 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
6897 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
6898 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
6899 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
6900 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
6901 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006902
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006903 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
6904 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
6905 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006906
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006907 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006908 defaults http_instances
6909 mode http
6910
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006911 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006912
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006913
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006914monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006915 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006916 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6917 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006918 Arguments :
6919 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
6920 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006921 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006922 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
6923 backend and its backup.
6924
6925 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
6926 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
6927 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
6928 servers in a list of backends.
6929
6930 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
6931 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
6932 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
6933 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
6934 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
6935 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
6936 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02006937 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
6938 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006939
6940 Example:
6941 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006942 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006943 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
6944 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
6945 monitor-uri /site_alive
6946 monitor fail if site_dead
6947
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02006948 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006949
6950
6951monitor-net <source>
6952 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
6953 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6954 yes | yes | yes | no
6955 Arguments :
6956 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
6957 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
6958 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
6959 followed by a mask.
6960
6961 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
6962 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006963 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006964 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
6965
6966 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
6967 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
6968 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
6969 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006970 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
6971 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
6972 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006973
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006974 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
6975 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
6976 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
6977 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
6978 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
6979 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006980
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01006981 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
6982 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006983
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006984 Example :
6985 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
6986 frontend www
6987 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
6988
6989 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
6990
6991
6992monitor-uri <uri>
6993 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
6994 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6995 yes | yes | yes | no
6996 Arguments :
6997 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
6998 health status instead of forwarding the request.
6999
7000 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
7001 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
7002 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
7003 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
7004 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
7005 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
7006 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
7007 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
7008
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01007009 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007010 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
7011 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
7012 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
7013 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
7014 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
7015 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007016
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01007017 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
7018 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
7019 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
7020 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
7021
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007022 Example :
7023 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
7024 frontend www
7025 mode http
7026 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
7027
7028 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
7029
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007030
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007031option abortonclose
7032no option abortonclose
7033 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
7034 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7035 yes | no | yes | yes
7036 Arguments : none
7037
7038 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
7039 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
7040 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
7041 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007042 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007043 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
7044 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
7045 encountered while delivering the response.
7046
7047 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
7048 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
7049 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
7050 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
7051 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
7052 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007053 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007054 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007055 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007056 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
7057 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
7058 still not served and not pollute the servers.
7059
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007060 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
7061 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007062 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
7063 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
7064 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
7065 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
7066 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
7067 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007068 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007069
7070 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7071 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7072
7073 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
7074
7075
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007076option accept-invalid-http-request
7077no option accept-invalid-http-request
7078 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
7079 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7080 yes | yes | yes | no
7081 Arguments : none
7082
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007083 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007084 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007085 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007086 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7087 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7088 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7089 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7090 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007091 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
7092 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
7093 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
7094 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007095 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007096 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02007097 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
7098 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
7099 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007100
7101 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7102 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7103 been confirmed.
7104
7105 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7106 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007107 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
7108 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007109 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7110
7111 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7112 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7113
7114 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
7115 stats socket.
7116
7117
7118option accept-invalid-http-response
7119no option accept-invalid-http-response
7120 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
7121 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7122 yes | no | yes | yes
7123 Arguments : none
7124
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007125 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007126 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007127 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007128 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7129 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7130 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7131 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7132 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007133 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
7134 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
7135 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007136
7137 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7138 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7139 been confirmed.
7140
7141 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7142 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
7143 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
7144 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7145
7146 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7147 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7148
7149 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
7150 stats socket.
7151
7152
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007153option allbackups
7154no option allbackups
7155 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
7156 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7157 yes | no | yes | yes
7158 Arguments : none
7159
7160 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
7161 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
7162 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
7163 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
7164 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
7165 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
7166 order between the backup servers anymore.
7167
7168 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
7169 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
7170
7171 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7172 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7173
7174
7175option checkcache
7176no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08007177 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007178 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7179 yes | no | yes | yes
7180 Arguments : none
7181
7182 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
7183 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007184 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007185 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
7186 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007187 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007188
7189 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007190 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007191 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007192 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
7193 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007194 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007195 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01007196 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
7197 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007198 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01007199 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
7200 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007201 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007202 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
7203 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
7204 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
7205 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
7206 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
7207 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
7208 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
7209 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
7210 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
7211
7212 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007213 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
7214 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
7215 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
7216 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007217
7218 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
7219 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007220 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007221 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007222
7223 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7224 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7225
7226
7227option clitcpka
7228no option clitcpka
7229 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
7230 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7231 yes | yes | yes | no
7232 Arguments : none
7233
7234 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7235 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007236 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007237 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7238
7239 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7240 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7241 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7242 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7243
7244 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7245 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7246 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7247 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7248 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7249
7250 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7251
7252 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7253 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7254 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
7255
7256 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7257 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7258
7259 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
7260
7261
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007262option contstats
7263 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
7264 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7265 yes | yes | yes | no
7266 Arguments : none
7267
7268 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
7269 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
7270 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
7271 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01007272 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
7273 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
7274 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
7275 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
7276 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007277
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02007278option disable-h2-upgrade
7279no option disable-h2-upgrade
7280 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
7281 connection.
7282 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7283 yes | yes | yes | no
7284 Arguments : none
7285
7286 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
7287 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
7288 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
7289 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
7290 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be used to
7291 disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only supported
7292 for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to force the
7293 HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind line.
7294
7295 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7296 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007297
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007298option dontlog-normal
7299no option dontlog-normal
7300 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
7301 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7302 yes | yes | yes | no
7303 Arguments : none
7304
7305 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
7306 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
7307 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
7308 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
7309 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
7310 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
7311 logged.
7312
7313 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
7314 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
7315 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
7316
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007317 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007318 logging.
7319
7320
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007321option dontlognull
7322no option dontlognull
7323 Enable or disable logging of null connections
7324 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7325 yes | yes | yes | no
7326 Arguments : none
7327
7328 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
7329 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
7330 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
7331 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
7332 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
7333 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007334 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
7335 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
7336 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007337
7338 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007339 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007340 would not be logged.
7341
7342 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7343 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7344
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007345 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
7346 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007347
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007348
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007349option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007350 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
7351 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7352 yes | yes | yes | yes
7353 Arguments :
7354 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7355 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007356 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007357 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007358
7359 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
7360 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
7361 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
7362 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
7363 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
7364 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
7365 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007366 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
7367 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7368 possible that the client has already brought one.
7369
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007370 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007371 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007372 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007373 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007374 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007375 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007376
7377 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7378 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7379 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7380 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7381 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7382 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7383 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7384
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007385 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
7386 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
7387 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
7388 are under the control of the end-user.
7389
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007390 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007391 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7392 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007393 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
7394 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
7395 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007396
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007397 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007398 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
7399 frontend www
7400 mode http
7401 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
7402
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007403 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
7404 backend www
7405 mode http
7406 option forwardfor header X-Client
7407
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007408 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007409 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007410
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007411
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02007412option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7413no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7414 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
7415 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7416 yes | yes | yes | no
7417 Arguments : none
7418
7419 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7420 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7421 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7422 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7423 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7424 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7425 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7426
7427 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
7428 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
7429 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
7430 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7431 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
7432 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7433 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7434 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
7435 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7436 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7437
7438 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
7439
7440 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7441 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7442
7443 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
7444 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7445
7446
7447option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7448no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7449 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
7450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7451 yes | no | yes | yes
7452 Arguments : none
7453
7454 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7455 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7456 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7457 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7458 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7459 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7460 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7461
7462 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
7463 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
7464 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
7465 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7466 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
7467 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7468 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7469 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
7470 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7471 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7472
7473 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
7474
7475 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7476 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7477
7478 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
7479 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7480
7481
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007482option http-buffer-request
7483no option http-buffer-request
7484 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
7485 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7486 yes | yes | yes | yes
7487 Arguments : none
7488
7489 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
7490 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
7491 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
7492 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
7493 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
7494 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01007495 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
7496 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
7497 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
7498 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007499
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01007500 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007501
7502
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007503option http-ignore-probes
7504no option http-ignore-probes
7505 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
7506 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7507 yes | yes | yes | no
7508 Arguments : none
7509
7510 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
7511 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
7512 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
7513 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
7514 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
7515 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
7516 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
7517 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
7518 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007519 was received over a connection before it was closed;
7520 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007521 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
7522
7523 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
7524 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
7525 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
7526 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
7527 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
7528 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
7529 are often the only way to detect them.
7530
7531 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7532 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7533
7534 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
7535
7536
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007537option http-keep-alive
7538no option http-keep-alive
7539 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
7540 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7541 yes | yes | yes | yes
7542 Arguments : none
7543
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007544 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7545 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007546 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7547 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007548 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
7549 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
7550 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007551
7552 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
7553 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007554 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
7555 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
7556 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
7557 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
7558 situations where this option may be useful :
7559
7560 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007561 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007562
7563 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
7564 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
7565
7566 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
7567 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
7568 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
7569 request.
7570
7571 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
7572 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007573 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
7574 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
7575 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007576
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007577 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7578 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7579 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7580 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
7581 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7582 not set.
7583
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007584 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7585 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
7586 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007587
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007588 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007589 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01007590 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007591
7592
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007593option http-no-delay
7594no option http-no-delay
7595 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
7596 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7597 yes | yes | yes | yes
7598 Arguments : none
7599
7600 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
7601 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
7602 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
7603 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
7604 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
7605 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
7606 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
7607 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
7608 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
7609 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
7610 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
7611 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
7612 affected.
7613
7614 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
7615 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
7616 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
7617 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
7618 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
7619 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
7620 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
7621 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
7622 latency environments.
7623
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007624 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7625
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007626
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007627option http-pretend-keepalive
7628no option http-pretend-keepalive
7629 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
7630 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007631 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007632 Arguments : none
7633
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007634 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007635 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
7636 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
7637 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
7638 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
7639 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
7640 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
7641 consider the response complete.
7642
7643 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
7644 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
7645 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
7646 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007647 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007648 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
7649
7650 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
7651 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
7652 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
7653 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
7654 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
7655 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
7656 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
7657
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007658 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
7659 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
7660 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
7661 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
7662 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
7663 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007664
7665 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7666 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7667
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007668 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007669 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007670
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007671
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007672option http-server-close
7673no option http-server-close
7674 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
7675 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7676 yes | yes | yes | yes
7677 Arguments : none
7678
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007679 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7680 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7681 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7682 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007683 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
7684 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
7685 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
7686 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
7687 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
7688 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
7689 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
7690 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
7691 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
7692 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
7693 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007694
7695 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7696 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7697 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7698 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007699 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7700 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007701
7702 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7703 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007704 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7705 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7706 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007707
7708 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7709 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7710
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007711 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
7712 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007713
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007714option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007715no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007716 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
7717 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7718 yes | yes | yes | no
7719 Arguments : none
7720
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00007721 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007722 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
7723 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
7724 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
7725 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
7726 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
7727 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
7728
7729 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
7730 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007731 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
7732 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
7733 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007734
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01007735 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
7736 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
7737 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
7738 front of an existing proxy.
7739
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007740 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
7741
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007742 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007743
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007744option httpchk
7745option httpchk <uri>
7746option httpchk <method> <uri>
7747option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02007748 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007749 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7750 yes | no | yes | yes
7751 Arguments :
7752 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
7753 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
7754 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
7755 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
7756 ones.
7757
7758 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
7759 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
7760 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
7761
7762 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
7763 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
7764 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007765 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007766
7767 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
7768 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
7769 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
7770 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
7771 the lack of any response.
7772
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02007773 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
7774 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
7775 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
7776 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
7777
7778 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
7779 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
7780 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007781
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02007782 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
7783 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02007784 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007785 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02007786 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007787
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007788 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
7789 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
7790 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
7791 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
7792
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007793 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02007794 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
7795 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
7796 backend https_relay
7797 mode tcp
7798 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
7799 http-check send hdr Host www
7800 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007801
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09007802 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
7803 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
7804 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007805
7806
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007807option httpclose
7808no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007809 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007810 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7811 yes | yes | yes | yes
7812 Arguments : none
7813
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007814 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7815 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7816 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7817 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007818 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007819
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007820 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
7821 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05007822 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007823 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
7824 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007825
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007826 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
7827 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
7828 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007829
7830 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7831 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007832 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
7833 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7834 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007835
7836 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7837 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7838
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007839 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007840
7841
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007842option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007843 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
7844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007845 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007846 Arguments :
7847 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
7848 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
7849 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007850 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007851 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007852
7853 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7854 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7855 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
7856 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
7857 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
7858 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
7859 ports.
7860
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01007861 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
7862 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007863
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007864 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7865
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007866 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007867
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007868
7869option http_proxy
7870no option http_proxy
7871 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
7872 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7873 yes | yes | yes | yes
7874 Arguments : none
7875
7876 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
7877 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
7878 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
7879 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
7880 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
7881
7882 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
7883 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007884 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
7885 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007886
7887 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7888 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7889
7890 Example :
7891 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
7892 backend direct_forward
7893 option httpclose
7894 option http_proxy
7895
7896 See also : "option httpclose"
7897
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007898
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007899option independent-streams
7900no option independent-streams
7901 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007902 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7903 yes | yes | yes | yes
7904 Arguments : none
7905
7906 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
7907 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
7908 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
7909 receive data or not.
7910
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007911 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007912 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
7913 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
7914 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
7915 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
7916 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
7917 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
7918 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
7919 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
7920 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
7921 socket buffers.
7922
7923 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
7924 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
7925 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
7926 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
7927 slow lines, so use it with caution.
7928
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007929 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007930
7931
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02007932option ldap-check
7933 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
7934 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7935 yes | no | yes | yes
7936 Arguments : none
7937
7938 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
7939 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
7940 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
7941 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
7942
7943 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
7944 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
7945
7946 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
7947 configure it.
7948
7949 Example :
7950 option ldap-check
7951
7952 See also : "option httpchk"
7953
7954
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007955option external-check
7956 Use external processes for server health checks
7957 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7958 yes | no | yes | yes
7959
7960 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
7961 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
7962 command".
7963
7964 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
7965
7966 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
7967
7968
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007969option log-health-checks
7970no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007971 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007972 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7973 yes | no | yes | yes
7974 Arguments : none
7975
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007976 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
7977 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
7978 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007979
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007980 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
7981 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
7982 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
7983 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
7984 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
7985
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007986 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007987 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007988
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007989 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
7990 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
7991 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007992
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007993
7994option log-separate-errors
7995no option log-separate-errors
7996 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
7997 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7998 yes | yes | yes | no
7999 Arguments : none
8000
8001 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
8002 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
8003 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
8004 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
8005 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
8006 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
8007 provides very important information.
8008
8009 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
8010 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
8011 error logs.
8012
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008013 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008014 logging.
8015
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008016
8017option logasap
8018no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008019 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008020 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8021 yes | yes | yes | no
8022 Arguments : none
8023
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008024 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
8025 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
8026 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
8027 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
8028
8029 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
8030 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
8031 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
8032 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
8033 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008034 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008035 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
8036 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
8037 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
8038 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008039 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008040
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008041 Examples :
8042 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
8043 mode http
8044 option httplog
8045 option logasap
8046 log 192.168.2.200 local3
8047
8048 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8049 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8050 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
8051 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
8052
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008053 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008054 logging.
8055
8056
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008057option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008058 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008059 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8060 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008061 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008062 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
8063 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008064 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
8065 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008066
8067 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
8068 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008069 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008070 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
8071 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
8072 in the MySQL table, like this :
8073
8074 USE mysql;
8075 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
8076 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
8077
8078 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008079 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008080 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
8081 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
8082 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
8083 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
8084 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
8085 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
8086 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
8087
8088 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
8089 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008090
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02008091 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008092
8093 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
8094 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
8095 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8096 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008097 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
8098 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008099
8100 See also: "option httpchk"
8101
8102
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008103option nolinger
8104no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008105 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008106 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8107 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008108 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008109
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008110 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008111 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
8112 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
8113 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
8114 connections.
8115
8116 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
8117 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
8118 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
8119 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
8120 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
8121 this too.
8122
8123 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
8124 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
8125 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
8126
8127 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
8128 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
8129 for servers.
8130
8131 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8132 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8133
8134
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008135option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
8136 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
8137 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8138 yes | yes | yes | yes
8139 Arguments :
8140 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8141 matching <network>
8142 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
8143 header name.
8144
8145 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
8146 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
8147 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
8148 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
8149 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
8150 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
8151 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
8152 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
8153 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8154 possible that the client has already brought one.
8155
8156 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
8157 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
8158 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
8159 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
8160 header and requires different one.
8161
8162 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8163 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8164 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8165 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8166 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8167 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
8168 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
8169
8170 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
8171 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8172 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
8173 both are defined.
8174
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008175 Examples :
8176 # Original Destination address
8177 frontend www
8178 mode http
8179 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
8180
8181 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
8182 backend www
8183 mode http
8184 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
8185
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008186 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008187
8188
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008189option persist
8190no option persist
8191 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
8192 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8193 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008194 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008195
8196 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
8197 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
8198 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
8199 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
8200 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
8201 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
8202 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
8203 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
8204 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
8205 redirected to another valid server.
8206
8207 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8208 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8209
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01008210 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008211
8212
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01008213option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
8214 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
8215 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8216 yes | no | yes | yes
8217 Arguments :
8218 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
8219 PostgreSQL server.
8220
8221 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
8222 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
8223 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
8224 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
8225
8226 See also: "option httpchk"
8227
8228
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008229option prefer-last-server
8230no option prefer-last-server
8231 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
8232 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8233 yes | no | yes | yes
8234 Arguments : none
8235
8236 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
8237 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
8238 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
8239 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
8240 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
8241 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
8242 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
8243 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
8244 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008245 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
8246 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02008247 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
8248 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
8249 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008250 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
8251 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
8252 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008253
8254 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8255 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8256
8257 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
8258
8259
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008260option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008261option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008262no option redispatch
8263 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
8264 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8265 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008266 Arguments :
8267 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
8268 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
8269 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008270 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008271 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008272 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008273 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
8274 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
8275 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
8276
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008277
8278 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
8279 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
8280 be able to access the service anymore.
8281
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01008282 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
8283 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008284
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02008285 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
8286 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
8287 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
8288 following order:
8289
8290 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
8291
8292 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
8293 list, or
8294
8295 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
8296
8297 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
8298 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
8299
8300 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
8301 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
8302 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
8303 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
8304
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008305 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008306 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
8307 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008308
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008309 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8310 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8311
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008312 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008313
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008314
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008315option redis-check
8316 Use redis health checks for server testing
8317 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8318 yes | no | yes | yes
8319 Arguments : none
8320
8321 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
8322 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8323 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
8324 find the "+PONG" response message.
8325
8326 Example :
8327 option redis-check
8328
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03008329 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008330
8331
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008332option smtpchk
8333option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
8334 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
8335 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8336 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008337 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008338 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02008339 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008340 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
8341
8342 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
8343 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
8344 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
8345
8346 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
8347 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
8348 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
8349 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
8350 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
8351 dead server.
8352
8353 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
8354 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008355 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008356 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
8357
8358 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
8359 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
8360 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8361 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008362 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008363
8364 Example :
8365 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
8366
8367 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
8368
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008369
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02008370option socket-stats
8371no option socket-stats
8372
8373 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
8374 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8375 yes | yes | yes | no
8376
8377 Arguments : none
8378
8379
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008380option splice-auto
8381no option splice-auto
8382 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
8383 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8384 yes | yes | yes | yes
8385 Arguments : none
8386
8387 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
8388 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008389 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008390 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008391 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008392 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
8393 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
8394 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
8395 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8396
8397 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
8398 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
8399 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
8400 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
8401 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
8402 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
8403 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
8404 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
8405 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
8406 keyword.
8407
8408 Example :
8409 option splice-auto
8410
8411 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8412 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8413
8414 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
8415 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8416
8417
8418option splice-request
8419no option splice-request
8420 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
8421 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8422 yes | yes | yes | yes
8423 Arguments : none
8424
8425 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008426 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008427 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8428 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8429 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8430 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8431
8432 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8433
8434 Example :
8435 option splice-request
8436
8437 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8438 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8439
8440 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
8441 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8442
8443
8444option splice-response
8445no option splice-response
8446 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
8447 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8448 yes | yes | yes | yes
8449 Arguments : none
8450
8451 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008452 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008453 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8454 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8455 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8456 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8457
8458 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8459
8460 Example :
8461 option splice-response
8462
8463 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8464 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8465
8466 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
8467 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8468
8469
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01008470option spop-check
8471 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
8472 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8473 no | no | no | yes
8474 Arguments : none
8475
8476 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
8477 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8478 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
8479 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
8480
8481 Example :
8482 option spop-check
8483
8484 See also : "option httpchk"
8485
8486
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008487option srvtcpka
8488no option srvtcpka
8489 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
8490 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8491 yes | no | yes | yes
8492 Arguments : none
8493
8494 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8495 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008496 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008497 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8498
8499 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8500 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8501 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8502 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8503
8504 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8505 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8506 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8507 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8508 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8509
8510 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8511
8512 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8513 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8514 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
8515
8516 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8517 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8518
8519 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
8520
8521
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008522option ssl-hello-chk
8523 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
8524 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8525 yes | no | yes | yes
8526 Arguments : none
8527
8528 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
8529 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
8530 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
8531 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
8532 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
8533 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
8534 hello message.
8535
8536 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
8537 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
8538 messages, which is appreciable.
8539
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008540 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
8541 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
8542 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008543
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008544 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
8545
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008546
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008547option tcp-check
8548 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
8549 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8550 yes | no | yes | yes
8551
8552 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
8553 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
8554
8555 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
8556 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
8557 attempt, which remains the default mode.
8558
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008559 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008560 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
8561 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
8562 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
8563 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
8564 only.
8565
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008566 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008567 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
8568 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
8569 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
8570 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
8571
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008572 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008573 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
8574 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008575 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008576 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
8577 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
8578 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
8579 the respective protocols.
8580 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008581 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008582
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008583 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008584
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008585 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
8586 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
8587 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
8588 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008589
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008590 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
8591 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
8592 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01008593
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008594
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008595 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008596 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008597 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008598 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008599
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008600 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008601 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008602 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008603
8604 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
8605 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008606 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008607 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008608 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008609 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008610 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008611 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008612 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8613 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008614 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008615 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8616 tcp-check expect string +OK
8617
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008618 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008619 (send many headers before analyzing)
8620 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008621 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008622 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
8623 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
8624 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
8625 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008626 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008627
8628
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008629 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008630
8631
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008632option tcp-smart-accept
8633no option tcp-smart-accept
8634 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
8635 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8636 yes | yes | yes | no
8637 Arguments : none
8638
8639 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
8640 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
8641 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
8642 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
8643 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
8644 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
8645
8646 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
8647 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
8648 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
8649 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
8650
8651 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
8652 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
8653 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008654 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008655
8656 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
8657 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
8658 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
8659
8660 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
8661 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
8662 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
8663
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02008664 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
8665
8666
8667option tcp-smart-connect
8668no option tcp-smart-connect
8669 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
8670 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8671 yes | no | yes | yes
8672 Arguments : none
8673
8674 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
8675 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
8676 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
8677 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
8678 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
8679
8680 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
8681 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
8682 complex.
8683
8684 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
8685 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
8686 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
8687
8688 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8689 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8690
8691 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
8692
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008693
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008694option tcpka
8695 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
8696 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8697 yes | yes | yes | yes
8698 Arguments : none
8699
8700 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8701 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008702 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008703 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8704
8705 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8706 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8707 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8708 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8709
8710 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8711 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8712 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8713 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8714 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8715
8716 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8717
8718 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
8719 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
8720 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
8721 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
8722 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
8723 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
8724 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
8725 backends.
8726
8727 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
8728
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008729
8730option tcplog
8731 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
8732 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008733 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008734 Arguments : none
8735
8736 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8737 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8738 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
8739 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
8740 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
8741 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
8742 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
8743 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
8744
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008745 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8746
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008747 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008748
8749
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008750option transparent
8751no option transparent
8752 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8753 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008754 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008755 Arguments : none
8756
8757 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
8758 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8759 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8760 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8761 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8762 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8763 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8764 appropriate server.
8765
8766 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8767 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8768
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01008769 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008770 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008771
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008772
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008773external-check command <command>
8774 Executable to run when performing an external-check
8775 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8776 yes | no | yes | yes
8777
8778 Arguments :
8779 <command> is the external command to run
8780
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008781 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
8782
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008783 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008784
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008785 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
8786 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
8787 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
8788 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
8789 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
8790 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008791
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01008792 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
8793
8794 Environment variables :
8795 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
8796 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
8797
8798 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
8799
8800 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
8801
8802 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
8803 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
8804 for a UNIX socket).
8805
8806 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
8807
8808 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
8809
8810 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
8811
8812 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
8813
8814 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
8815
8816 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
8817 socket).
8818
8819 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
8820 the command may be set using "external-check path".
8821
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02008822 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
8823
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008824 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
8825 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
8826 failed.
8827
8828 Example :
8829 external-check command /bin/true
8830
8831 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
8832
8833
8834external-check path <path>
8835 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
8836 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8837 yes | no | yes | yes
8838
8839 Arguments :
8840 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
8841
8842 The default path is "".
8843
8844 Example :
8845 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
8846
8847 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
8848 "external-check command"
8849
8850
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008851persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008852persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008853 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
8854 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8855 yes | no | yes | yes
8856 Arguments :
8857 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02008858 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
8859 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008860
8861 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
8862 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008863 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008864 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
8865 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
8866 forwarded to this server.
8867
8868 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
8869 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
8870 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008871 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008872 a single "listen" section.
8873
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02008874 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
8875 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
8876 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
8877
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008878 Example :
8879 listen tse-farm
8880 bind :3389
8881 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
8882 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8883 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
8884 # apply RDP cookie persistence
8885 persist rdp-cookie
8886 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008887 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008888 balance rdp-cookie
8889 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
8890 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
8891
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008892 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
8893 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008894
8895
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008896rate-limit sessions <rate>
8897 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
8898 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8899 yes | yes | yes | no
8900 Arguments :
8901 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
8902 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
8903
8904 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
8905 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
8906 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
8907 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
8908 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
8909 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
8910
8911 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
8912 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
8913 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
8914 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
8915
8916 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
8917 listen smtp
8918 mode tcp
8919 bind :25
8920 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02008921 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008922
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02008923 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
8924 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
8925 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008926
8927 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
8928
8929
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008930redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8931redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8932redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008933 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
8934 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8935 no | yes | yes | yes
8936
8937 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01008938 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008939
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008940 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008941 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008942 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
8943 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
8944 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008945
8946 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
8947 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
8948 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
8949 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
8950 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008951 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
8952 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
8953 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
8954 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008955
8956 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
8957 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
8958 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
8959 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
8960 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
8961 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008962 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008963 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008964 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
8965 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
8966 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008967
8968 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01008969 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
8970 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
8971 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02008972 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01008973 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
8974 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
8975 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
8976 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008977
8978 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008979 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008980
8981 - "drop-query"
8982 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
8983 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
8984 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
8985 with a location-type redirect.
8986
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008987 - "append-slash"
8988 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
8989 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
8990 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
8991 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
8992
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008993 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
8994 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
8995 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
8996 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
8997 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
8998 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
8999 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
9000
9001 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
9002 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
9003 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
9004 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
9005 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
9006 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
9007 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009008
9009 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
9010 acl clear dst_port 80
9011 acl secure dst_port 8080
9012 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009013 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009014 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009015 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
9016
9017 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009018 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
9019 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
9020 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009021 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009022
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009023 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
9024 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
9025 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
9026
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009027 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01009028 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009029
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009030 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02009031 http-request redirect code 301 location \
9032 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
9033 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009034
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009035 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009036
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01009037
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009038retries <value>
9039 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
9040 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9041 yes | no | yes | yes
9042 Arguments :
9043 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
9044 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
9045 default value is 3.
9046
9047 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
9048 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
9049 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
9050
9051 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009052 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
9053 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009054
9055 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
9056 server even if a cookie references a different server.
9057
9058 See also : "option redispatch"
9059
9060
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009061retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +02009062 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
9063 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
9064 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009065 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9066 yes | no | yes | yes
9067 Arguments :
9068 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
9069 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
9070 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
9071 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
9072
9073 none never retry
9074
9075 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
9076 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
9077
9078 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
9079 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
9080 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
9081 request timeout on the server side, poor network
9082 condition, or a server crash or restart while
9083 processing the request.
9084
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02009085 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
9086 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
9087 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
9088 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
9089 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
9090 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
9091 overflow attack for example).
9092
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009093 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
9094 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
9095 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
9096 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
9097 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
9098 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
9099 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
9100 amplify denial of service attacks.
9101
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02009102 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
9103 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
9104 considered to be safe to retry.
9105
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009106 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
9107 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
9108 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
9109 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
9110
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02009111 all-retryable-errors
9112 retry request for any error that are considered
9113 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
9114 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
9115 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
9116
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009117 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
9118 not cumulative.
9119
9120 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
9121 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
9122 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
9123 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
9124
9125 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
9126 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
9127 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
9128 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
9129 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
9130 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
9131 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
9132 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
9133 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
9134 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
9135 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
9136 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
9137
9138 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
9139 should not use this directive.
9140
9141 The default is "conn-failure".
9142
9143 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
9144
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009145server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009146 Declare a server in a backend
9147 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9148 no | no | yes | yes
9149 Arguments :
9150 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009151 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009152 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009153
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009154 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
9155 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
9156 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
9157 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02009158 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
9159 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
9160 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
9161 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
9162 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009163 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
9164 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
9165 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
9166 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
9167 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9168 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9169 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009170 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02009171 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
9172 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
9173 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
9174 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
9175 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
9176 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009177 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9178 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01009179 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
9180 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009181
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009182 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009183 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
9184 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
9185 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
9186 adding this value to the client's port.
9187
9188 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
9189 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009190 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009191
9192 Examples :
9193 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
9194 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009195 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009196 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
9197 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
9198 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009199
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02009200 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
9201 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
9202 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
9203 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
9204 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
9205
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009206 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
9207 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009208
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009209server-state-file-name [<file>]
9210 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
9211 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
9212 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
9213 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
9214 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
9215 global directive "server-state-file-base".
9216
9217 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
9218 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
9219
9220 global
9221 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
9222
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01009223 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009224 load-server-state-from-file
9225
9226 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
9227 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009228
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02009229server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
9230 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
9231 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
9232 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9233 no | no | yes | yes
9234
9235 Arguments:
9236 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
9237
9238 <num | range>
9239 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
9240 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
9241 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
9242 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
9243
9244 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
9245
9246 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
9247
9248 <params*>
9249 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
9250 keyword.
9251
9252 Examples:
9253 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
9254 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
9255 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
9256
9257 # or
9258 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
9259
9260 # would be equivalent to:
9261 server srv1 google.com:80 check
9262 server srv2 google.com:80 check
9263 server srv3 google.com:80 check
9264
9265
9266
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009267source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009268source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009269source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009270 Set the source address for outgoing connections
9271 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9272 yes | no | yes | yes
9273 Arguments :
9274 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
9275 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009276
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009277 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009278 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
9279 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
9280 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
9281 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
9282 supported prefixes are :
9283 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9284 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9285 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009286 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02009287 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9288 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009289
9290 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
9291 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009292 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
9293 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
9294 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009295
9296 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
9297 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
9298 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
9299 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
9300 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
9301 <addr>.
9302
9303 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
9304 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
9305 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
9306 port.
9307
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009308 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
9309 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
9310 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
9311 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01009312 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009313 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
9314 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
9315 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
9316 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
9317 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
9318 HTTP header.
9319
9320 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
9321 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009322 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009323 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
9324 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
9325 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
9326 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
9327 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
9328 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
9329 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
9330
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009331 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
9332 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
9333 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
9334 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
9335 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
9336 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
9337
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009338 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
9339 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
9340 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
9341 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
9342
9343 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
9344 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
9345 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
9346 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
9347 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
9348 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
9349
9350 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
9351 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
9352 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
9353 there are two methods :
9354
9355 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
9356 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
9357 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
9358 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
9359 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
9360 of the client ranges may be used.
9361
9362 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
9363 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
9364 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
9365 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
9366 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
9367 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
9368 same session.
9369
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009370 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
9371 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
9372 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009373 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009374
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02009375 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
9376
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009377 Examples :
9378 backend private
9379 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
9380 source 192.168.1.200
9381
9382 backend transparent_ssl1
9383 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
9384 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9385
9386 backend transparent_ssl2
9387 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
9388 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
9389 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
9390
9391 backend transparent_ssl3
9392 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
9393 # is more conntrack-friendly.
9394 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9395
9396 backend transparent_smtp
9397 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
9398 # with Tproxy version 4.
9399 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
9400
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009401 backend transparent_http
9402 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
9403 # proxy.
9404 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
9405
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009406 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009407 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
9408
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009409
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009410stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
9411 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
9412 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009413 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009414
9415 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
9416 matched.
9417
9418 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
9419 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
9420
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009421 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9422 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009423 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009424
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01009425 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
9426 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
9427 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
9428 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009429
9430 Example :
9431 # statistics admin level only for localhost
9432 backend stats_localhost
9433 stats enable
9434 stats admin if LOCALHOST
9435
9436 Example :
9437 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
9438 backend stats_auth
9439 stats enable
9440 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
9441 stats admin if TRUE
9442
9443 Example :
9444 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
9445 userlist stats-auth
9446 group admin users admin
9447 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
9448 group readonly users haproxy
9449 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
9450
9451 backend stats_auth
9452 stats enable
9453 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
9454 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
9455 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
9456 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
9457
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009458 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
9459 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
9460 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009461
9462
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009463stats auth <user>:<passwd>
9464 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
9465 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009466 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009467 Arguments :
9468 <user> is a user name to grant access to
9469
9470 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
9471
9472 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
9473 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
9474 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
9475 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
9476 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
9477 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
9478
9479 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
9480 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
9481 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02009482 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009483
9484 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
9485 report using "stats scope".
9486
9487 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9488 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9489 unobvious parameters.
9490
9491 Example :
9492 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9493 backend public_www
9494 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9495 stats enable
9496 stats hide-version
9497 stats scope .
9498 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009499 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009500 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9501 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9502
9503 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9504 backend private_monitoring
9505 stats enable
9506 stats uri /admin?stats
9507 stats refresh 5s
9508
9509 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
9510
9511
9512stats enable
9513 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
9514 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009515 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009516 Arguments : none
9517
9518 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
9519 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
9520 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
9521 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
9522 - stats auth : no authentication
9523 - stats scope : no restriction
9524
9525 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9526 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9527 unobvious parameters.
9528
9529 Example :
9530 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9531 backend public_www
9532 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9533 stats enable
9534 stats hide-version
9535 stats scope .
9536 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009537 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009538 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9539 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9540
9541 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9542 backend private_monitoring
9543 stats enable
9544 stats uri /admin?stats
9545 stats refresh 5s
9546
9547 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9548
9549
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009550stats hide-version
9551 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009552 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009553 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009554 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009555
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009556 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
9557 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
9558 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
9559 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
9560 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
9561 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009562
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009563 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9564 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9565 unobvious parameters.
9566
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009567 Example :
9568 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9569 backend public_www
9570 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009571 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009572 stats hide-version
9573 stats scope .
9574 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009575 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009576 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9577 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009578
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009579 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9580 backend private_monitoring
9581 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009582 stats uri /admin?stats
9583 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01009584
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009585 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009586
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01009587
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02009588stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
9589 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
9590 Access control for statistics
9591
9592 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9593 no | no | yes | yes
9594
9595 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
9596 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
9597 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
9598 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
9599 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
9600 should be asked to enter a username and password.
9601
9602 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
9603 instance.
9604
9605 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
9606 about ACL usage.
9607
9608
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009609stats realm <realm>
9610 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
9611 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009612 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009613 Arguments :
9614 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
9615 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
9616 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
9617
9618 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
9619 using a backslash ('\').
9620
9621 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
9622 only related to authentication.
9623
9624 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9625 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9626 unobvious parameters.
9627
9628 Example :
9629 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9630 backend public_www
9631 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9632 stats enable
9633 stats hide-version
9634 stats scope .
9635 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009636 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009637 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9638 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9639
9640 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9641 backend private_monitoring
9642 stats enable
9643 stats uri /admin?stats
9644 stats refresh 5s
9645
9646 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
9647
9648
9649stats refresh <delay>
9650 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
9651 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009652 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009653 Arguments :
9654 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
9655 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
9656 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
9657 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
9658 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
9659 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
9660
9661 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
9662 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
9663 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
9664 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
9665
9666 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9667 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9668 unobvious parameters.
9669
9670 Example :
9671 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9672 backend public_www
9673 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9674 stats enable
9675 stats hide-version
9676 stats scope .
9677 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009678 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009679 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9680 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9681
9682 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9683 backend private_monitoring
9684 stats enable
9685 stats uri /admin?stats
9686 stats refresh 5s
9687
9688 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9689
9690
9691stats scope { <name> | "." }
9692 Enable statistics and limit access scope
9693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009694 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009695 Arguments :
9696 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
9697 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
9698 section in which the statement appears.
9699
9700 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
9701 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
9702 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
9703 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
9704 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
9705 exists.
9706
9707 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9708 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9709 unobvious parameters.
9710
9711 Example :
9712 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9713 backend public_www
9714 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9715 stats enable
9716 stats hide-version
9717 stats scope .
9718 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009719 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009720 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9721 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9722
9723 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9724 backend private_monitoring
9725 stats enable
9726 stats uri /admin?stats
9727 stats refresh 5s
9728
9729 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9730
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009731
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009732stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009733 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
9734 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009735 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009736
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009737 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009738 description from global section is automatically used instead.
9739
9740 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9741 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
9742
9743 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9744 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009745 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009746
9747 Example :
9748 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9749 backend private_monitoring
9750 stats enable
9751 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
9752 stats uri /admin?stats
9753 stats refresh 5s
9754
9755 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
9756 global section.
9757
9758
9759stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009760 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
9761 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9762 yes | yes | yes | yes
9763 Arguments : none
9764
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009765 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009766 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
9767 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
9768 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
9769 - IP (socket, server)
9770 - cookie (backend, server)
9771
9772 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9773 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009774 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009775
9776 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
9777
9778
9779stats show-node [ <name> ]
9780 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
9781 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009782 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009783 Arguments:
9784 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
9785 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
9786
9787 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9788 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009789 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009790
9791 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9792 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9793 unobvious parameters.
9794
9795 Example:
9796 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9797 backend private_monitoring
9798 stats enable
9799 stats show-node Europe-1
9800 stats uri /admin?stats
9801 stats refresh 5s
9802
9803 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
9804 section.
9805
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009806
9807stats uri <prefix>
9808 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
9809 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009810 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009811 Arguments :
9812 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
9813 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
9814 query string.
9815
9816 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
9817 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
9818 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
9819 possible to reach it in the application.
9820
9821 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009822 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009823 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
9824 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
9825 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
9826 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
9827
9828 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
9829 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
9830 an address or a port to statistics only.
9831
9832 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9833 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9834 unobvious parameters.
9835
9836 Example :
9837 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9838 backend public_www
9839 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9840 stats enable
9841 stats hide-version
9842 stats scope .
9843 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009844 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009845 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9846 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9847
9848 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9849 backend private_monitoring
9850 stats enable
9851 stats uri /admin?stats
9852 stats refresh 5s
9853
9854 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
9855
9856
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009857stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
9858 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009859 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009860 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009861
9862 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009863 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009864 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009865 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009866 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
9867
9868 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9869 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9870 the "stick-table" statement.
9871
9872 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
9873 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
9874 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
9875 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
9876 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
9877
9878 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9879 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
9880 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
9881 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
9882 transformation rules.
9883
9884 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9885 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9886 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9887 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9888 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9889 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9890 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9891
9892 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
9893 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
9894 ACL based conditions.
9895
9896 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
9897 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
9898 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
9899 matches can be used as fallbacks.
9900
9901 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
9902 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
9903 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
9904 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
9905
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009906 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9907 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009908 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009909
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009910 Example :
9911 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9912 # last 30 minutes
9913 backend pop
9914 mode tcp
9915 balance roundrobin
9916 stick store-request src
9917 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9918 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9919 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9920
9921 backend smtp
9922 mode tcp
9923 balance roundrobin
9924 stick match src table pop
9925 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9926 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9927
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009928 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009929 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009930
9931
9932stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9933 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
9934 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9935 no | no | yes | yes
9936
9937 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
9938 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
9939 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
9940 for writing more maintainable configurations.
9941
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009942 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9943 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009944 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009945
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009946 Examples :
9947 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01009948 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009949
9950 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
9951 stick match src table pop if !localhost
9952 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
9953
9954
9955 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
9956 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
9957 backend http
9958 mode http
9959 balance roundrobin
9960 stick on src table https
9961 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
9962 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
9963 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
9964
9965 backend https
9966 mode tcp
9967 balance roundrobin
9968 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9969 stick on src
9970 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9971 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9972
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009973 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009974
9975
9976stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9977 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
9978 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9979 no | no | yes | yes
9980
9981 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009982 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009983 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009984 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009985 server is selected.
9986
9987 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9988 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9989 the "stick-table" statement.
9990
9991 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9992 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9993 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
9994 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
9995 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
9996 address.
9997
9998 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9999 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
10000 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
10001 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
10002 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
10003 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
10004 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
10005 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
10006 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
10007 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
10008
10009 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10010 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10011 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10012 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10013 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10014 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10015 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10016
10017 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
10018 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10019 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
10020 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10021
10022 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
10023 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10024 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10025 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10026 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10027 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010028 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
10029 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10030 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10031 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10032 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10033 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010034
10035 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
10036 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
10037 the request.
10038
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010039 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10040 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010041 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010042
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010043 Example :
10044 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10045 # last 30 minutes
10046 backend pop
10047 mode tcp
10048 balance roundrobin
10049 stick store-request src
10050 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10051 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10052 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10053
10054 backend smtp
10055 mode tcp
10056 balance roundrobin
10057 stick match src table pop
10058 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10059 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10060
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010061 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010062 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010063
10064
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010065stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010066 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
10067 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080010068 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010069 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010070 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010071
10072 Arguments :
10073 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
10074 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
10075 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10076 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10077
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010010078 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
10079 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
10080 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10081 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10082
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010083 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
10084 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
10085 instance.
10086
10087 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
10088 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
10089 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
10090 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
10091 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
10092 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010093 to 32 characters.
10094
10095 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
10096 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
10097 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010098 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010099 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
10100 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010101
10102 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010103 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
10104 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010105 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
10106 increase.
10107
10108 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010109 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
10110 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
10111 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010112
10113 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
10114 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
10115 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
10116 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010117 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010118 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
10119 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
10120 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
10121 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
10122 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
10123 parameter (see below).
10124
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010125 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
10126 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
10127 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
10128 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
10129 soft restart.
10130
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020010131 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
10132 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010133
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010134 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
10135 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
10136 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
10137 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010138 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010139 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010140 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
10141 if not expiration delay is specified.
10142
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010143 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
10144 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
10145 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
10146 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010147 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
10148 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
10149 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
10150 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
10151 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
10152 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
10153 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
10154 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
10155 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
10156 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
10157 types and their arguments.
10158
10159 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
10160 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
10161 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
10162 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
10163
10164 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10165 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10166 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010167 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010168
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010169 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10170 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10171 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010172 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010173 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010174 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010175
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010176 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10177 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10178 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
10179 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
10180
10181 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
10182 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10183 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
10184 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
10185 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
10186 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
10187
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010188 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10189 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
10190 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
10191 they were received.
10192
10193 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10194 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
10195 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
10196 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
10197 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
10198
10199 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10200 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10201 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10202 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
10203 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10204
10205 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10206 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
10207 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
10208
10209 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10210 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10211 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10212 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
10213 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10214
10215 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10216 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
10217 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
10218 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
10219 the client side.
10220
10221 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10222 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10223 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10224 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
10225 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
10226 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
10227 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
10228
10229 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10230 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
10231 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
10232 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
10233 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
10234 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010235 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010236
10237 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10238 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10239 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10240 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
10241 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
10242 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10243
10244 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010245 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010246 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
10247 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
10248
10249 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10250 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10251 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10252 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10253 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10254 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
10255 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
10256 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
10257 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
10258 recommended for better fairness.
10259
10260 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010261 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010262 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
10263 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
10264
10265 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
10266 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10267 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10268 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10269 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10270 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
10271 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
10272 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
10273 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
10274 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010275
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010276 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
10277 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010278 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
10279 reference it.
10280
10281 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
10282 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010010283 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
10284 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
10285 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010286
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010287 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
10288 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
10289 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
10290 something that can be ignored.
10291
10292 Example:
10293 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
10294 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
10295 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
10296 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
10297
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010298 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010010299 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010300
10301
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010302stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010010303 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010304 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10305 no | no | yes | yes
10306
10307 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010308 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010309 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010310 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010311 server is selected.
10312
10313 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10314 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10315 the "stick-table" statement.
10316
10317 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10318 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10319 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
10320 when the response is a SSL server hello.
10321
10322 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10323 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
10324 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
10325 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
10326 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
10327 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010328 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010329 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
10330 rules.
10331
10332 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10333 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10334 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10335 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10336 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10337 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10338 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10339
10340 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
10341 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10342 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
10343 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10344
10345 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
10346 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10347 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10348 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10349 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10350 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010351 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
10352 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10353 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10354 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10355 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10356 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
10357 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
10358 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
10359 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010360
10361 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
10362
10363 Example :
10364 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
10365 backend https
10366 mode tcp
10367 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010368 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010369 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010370
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010371 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
10372 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
10373
10374 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
10375 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10376 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
10377
10378 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
10379 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010380
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010381 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
10382 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
10383 # at offset 44.
10384
10385 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
10386 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
10387
10388 # Learn on response if server hello.
10389 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010390
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010391 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10392 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10393
10394 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
10395 extraction.
10396
10397
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010398tcp-check comment <string>
10399 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
10400 it fails.
10401 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10402 yes | no | yes | yes
10403
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010404 Arguments :
10405 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
10406 rule fails.
10407
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010408 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
10409 user-friendly error reporting.
10410
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010411 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
10412 "tcp-check expect".
10413
10414
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010415tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
10416 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010417 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010418 Opens a new connection
10419 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010420 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010421
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010422 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010423 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10424
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010425 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040010426 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010427
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010428 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010429 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
10430 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010431 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010432
10433 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010434
10435 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
10436
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020010437 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
10438
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010439 ssl opens a ciphered connection
10440
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020010441 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
10442
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020010443 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
10444 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
10445 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10446 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
10447
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010448 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
10449 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
10450 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
10451 haproxy -vv.
10452
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010453 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010454
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010455 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
10456 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
10457 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
10458
10459 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
10460 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
10461 of the sequence.
10462
10463 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
10464 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
10465 do.
10466
10467 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
10468 unset-var or comment rules.
10469
10470 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010471 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
10472 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
10473 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
10474 option tcp-check
10475 tcp-check connect
10476 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
10477 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
10478 tcp-check send \r\n
10479 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
10480 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
10481 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
10482 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
10483 tcp-check send \r\n
10484 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
10485 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
10486
10487 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
10488 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010489 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010490 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
10491 tcp-check connect port 143
10492 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
10493 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
10494
10495 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
10496
10497
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010498tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010499 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020010500 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010501 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010502 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010503 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010504 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010505
10506 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010507 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10508
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010509 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
10510 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
10511 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
10512 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
10513 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
10514 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
10515 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
10516 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
10517 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
10518 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
10519
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010520 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010521 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
10522 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010523 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
10524 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
10525 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
10526
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010527 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
10528 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
10529 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010530 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
10531 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
10532 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, for
10533 example 404 with disable-on-404
10534 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
10535 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010536 By default "L7OK" is used.
10537
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010538 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
10539 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010540 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported :
10541 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
10542 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
10543 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
10544 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
10545 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010546
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010547 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010548 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010549 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
10550 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
10551 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
10552 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010553 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
10554
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020010555 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
10556 informational message reported in logs if the expect
10557 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
10558 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
10559
10560 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
10561 informational message reported in logs if an error
10562 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
10563 log-format string.
10564
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020010565 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
10566 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
10567 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10568 followed by some converters.
10569
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010570 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
10571 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
10572 with the usual backslash ('\').
10573 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010574 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010575 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
10576 used upper or lower case.
10577
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010578 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
10579
10580 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
10581 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10582 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
10583 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
10584 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
10585 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
10586 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
10587 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
10588
10589 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
10590 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10591 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
10592 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
10593 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
10594 expression.
10595
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020010596 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
10597 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10598 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
10599 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
10600 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
10601 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
10602
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010603 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
10604 in the response buffer. A health check response will
10605 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
10606 this exact hexadecimal string.
10607 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
10608
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010609 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
10610 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
10611 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
10612 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
10613 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
10614 size of the original response. As such, the expected
10615 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
10616 size.
10617
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020010618 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
10619 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
10620 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
10621 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
10622 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
10623 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
10624 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
10625 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
10626 in a binary string before matching the response's
10627 buffer.
10628
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010629 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
10630 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
10631 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
10632 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
10633 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
10634 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
10635 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
10636 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
10637 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
10638 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
10639 the null character.
10640
10641 Examples :
10642 # perform a POP check
10643 option tcp-check
10644 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
10645
10646 # perform an IMAP check
10647 option tcp-check
10648 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
10649
10650 # look for the redis master server
10651 option tcp-check
10652 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020010653 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010654 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10655 tcp-check expect string role:master
10656 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
10657 tcp-check expect string +OK
10658
10659
10660 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
10661 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
10662
10663
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010664tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
10665tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
10666 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
10667 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010668 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010669 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010670
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010671 Arguments :
10672 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10673
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010674 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
10675 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020010676
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010677 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
10678 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010679
10680 Examples :
10681 # look for the redis master server
10682 option tcp-check
10683 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10684 tcp-check expect string role:master
10685
10686 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10687 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
10688
10689
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010690tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
10691tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
10692 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
10693 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010694 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010695 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010696
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010697 Arguments :
10698 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010699
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010700 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
10701 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020010702
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010703 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
10704 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
10705 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010706
10707 Examples :
10708 # redis check in binary
10709 option tcp-check
10710 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
10711 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
10712
10713
10714 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10715 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
10716
10717
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010718tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010719 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010720 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010721 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010722
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010723 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010724 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
10725 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
10726 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
10727 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
10728 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
10729 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
10730 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
10731 and '-'.
10732
10733 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
10734
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010735 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010736 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
10737
10738
10739tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010740 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010741 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010742 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010743
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010744 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010745 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
10746 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
10747 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
10748 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
10749 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
10750 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
10751 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
10752 and '-'.
10753
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010754 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010755 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
10756
10757
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010758tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10759 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010760 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10761 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010762 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010763 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10764 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010765
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010766 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010767
10768 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
10769 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010770 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
10771 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
10772 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
10773 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
10774 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
10775 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010776
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010777 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10778 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10779 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
10780 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010781
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010782 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010783 - accept :
10784 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10785 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10786 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010787
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010788 - reject :
10789 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10790 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10791 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
10792 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
10793 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
10794 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
10795 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
10796 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
10797 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
10798 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
10799 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010800 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010801
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010802 - expect-proxy layer4 :
10803 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
10804 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
10805 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
10806 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
10807 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
10808 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
10809 hosts.
10810
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010811 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
10812 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
10813 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
10814 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
10815 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
10816 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
10817 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
10818 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
10819
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010820 - capture <sample> len <length> :
10821 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
10822 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
10823 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
10824 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
10825 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
10826 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
10827 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
10828 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010829 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
10830 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010831
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010832 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010833 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010834 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
10835 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
10836 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010837 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010838 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
10839 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
10840 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
10841 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
10842 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
10843 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
10844 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
10845 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010846
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010847 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010848 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010849 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010850 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010851 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
10852 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
10853 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010854
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010855 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
10856 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
10857 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
10858 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010859
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010860 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
10861 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
10862 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
10863 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
10864 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010865 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
10866 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
10867 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
10868 layer7 information is extracted.
10869
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010870 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
10871 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
10872 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
10873 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
10874 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010875
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010876 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10877 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10878 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10879 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10880
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010881 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10882 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10883 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10884 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10885
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010886 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
10887 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
10888 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
10889 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
10890 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010891
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010892 - set-src <expr> :
10893 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
10894 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
10895 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010896 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010897
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010898 Arguments:
10899 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10900 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010901
10902 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010903 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
10904
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010905 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
10906 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010907
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010908 - set-src-port <expr> :
10909 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
10910 expression.
10911
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010912 Arguments:
10913 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10914 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010915
10916 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010917 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
10918
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010919 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
10920 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
10921 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010922
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010923 - set-dst <expr> :
10924 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
10925 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
10926 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
10927 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10928 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10929
10930 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10931 followed by some converters.
10932
10933 Example:
10934
10935 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
10936 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
10937
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010938 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
10939 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
10940
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010941 - set-dst-port <expr> :
10942 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
10943 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10944 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10945
10946
10947 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10948 followed by some converters.
10949
10950 Example:
10951
10952 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
10953
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010954 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
10955 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
10956 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
10957
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010958 - "silent-drop" :
10959 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010960 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010961 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10962 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10963 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10964 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10965 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010966 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10967 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010968 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10969 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010970 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010971 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10972 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10973 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10974 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10975
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010976 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10977 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10978 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010979
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010980 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10981 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
10982 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010983
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010984 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010985 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010986 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010987
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010988 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
10989 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10990 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010991
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010992 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010993 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10994 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010995
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010996 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
10997
10998 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10999
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011000 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11001
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011002 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011003
11004
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011005tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11006 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011007 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011008 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011009 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011010 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11011 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011012
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011013 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011014
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011015 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011016 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11017 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
11018 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
11019 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011020
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011021 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
11022 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
11023 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
11024 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011025 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
11026 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
11027 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
11028 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
11029 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
11030 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011031 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011032 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011033
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011034 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11035 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11036 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11037 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011038
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011039 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011040 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011041 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011042 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11043 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011044 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011045 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011046 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011047 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011048 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011049 - set-dst <expr>
11050 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011051 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011052 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011053 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011054 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011055 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011056
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011057 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
11058 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011059 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
11060 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011061
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011062 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
11063 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
11064 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
11065 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
11066 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
11067 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011068
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011069 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011070 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11071 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011072
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011073 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020011074 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
11075 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
11076 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
11077 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011078 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
11079 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
11080 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011081
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011082 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011083 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
11084 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
11085 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011086
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011087 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
11088 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
11089
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011090 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011091 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
11092 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011093
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011094 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11095 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011096 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011097 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11098 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011099 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011100 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011101 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011102 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11103 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011104 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011105 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11106 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011107
11108 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11109 followed by some converters.
11110
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011111 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11112 <var-name>.
11113
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011114 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
11115 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
11116 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
11117 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
11118 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
11119
11120 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
11121 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
11122 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
11123 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
11124 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
11125 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
11126 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
11127 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
11128 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
11129 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
11130 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
11131
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011132 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11133 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11134 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11135 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11136 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11137
11138 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11139
11140 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11141
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011142 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
11143 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
11144 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
11145 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
11146 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
11147 evaluated.
11148
11149 Example:
11150 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
11151
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011152 Example:
11153
11154 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011155 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011156
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011157 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011158 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
11159 # and reject everything else.
11160 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
11161 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020011162 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011163 tcp-request content reject
11164
11165 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011166 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
11167 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11168 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011169 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011170
11171 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
11172 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11173 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011174 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011175 tcp-request content reject
11176
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011177 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011178 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011179 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011180 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011181 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
11182 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011183
11184 Example:
11185 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11186 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011187 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011188
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011189 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011190 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011191
11192 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011193 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011194 # protecting all our sites
11195 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011196 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11197 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011198 ...
11199 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
11200
11201 backend http_dynamic
11202 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011203 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011204 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011205 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011206 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011207 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011208 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011209
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011210 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011211
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030011212 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
11213 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011214
11215
11216tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
11217 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
11218 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011219 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011220 Arguments :
11221 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11222 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11223 as explained at the top of this document.
11224
11225 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
11226 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
11227 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
11228 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
11229 data for at most the specified amount of time.
11230
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011231 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
11232 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
11233 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
11234 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
11235
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011236 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
11237 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011238 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011239 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010011240 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
11241 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
11242 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
11243 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011244
11245 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
11246 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
11247 it pass through unaffected.
11248
11249 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
11250 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
11251 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011252 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011253 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
11254 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020011255 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
11256 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
11257 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011258
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011259 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011260 "timeout client".
11261
11262
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011263tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11264 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
11265 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11266 no | no | yes | yes
11267 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011268 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11269 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011270
11271 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11272
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011273 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011274 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11275 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011276 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
11277 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011278
11279 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
11280
11281 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11282 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11283 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11284 inserted.
11285
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011286 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011287 - accept :
11288 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11289 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11290 the rules evaluation.
11291
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011292 - close :
11293 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
11294 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
11295 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
11296 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
11297 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
11298 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011299 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011300 protocols.
11301
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011302 - reject :
11303 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11304 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011305 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011306
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011307 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
11308 Sets a variable.
11309
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011310 - unset-var(<var-name>)
11311 Unsets a variable.
11312
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011313 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11314 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11315 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11316 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11317
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011318 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11319 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11320 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11321 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11322
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011323 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
11324 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11325 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11326 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11327 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011328
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011329 - "silent-drop" :
11330 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011331 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011332 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11333 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11334 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11335 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11336 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011337 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11338 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011339 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11340 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011341 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011342 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11343 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11344 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11345 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11346
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011347 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
11348 Send a group of SPOE messages.
11349
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011350 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11351 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11352 for changing the default action to a reject.
11353
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011354 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
11355 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
11356 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
11357 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011358 period.
11359
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011360 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
11361 declared inline.
11362
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011363 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11364 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011365 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011366 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11367 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011368 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011369 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011370 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011371 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11372 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011373 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011374 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11375 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011376
11377 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11378 followed by some converters.
11379
11380 Example:
11381
11382 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
11383
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011384 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11385 <var-name>.
11386
11387 Example:
11388
11389 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
11390
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011391 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11392 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11393 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11394 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11395 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11396
11397 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11398
11399 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11400
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011401 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11402
11403 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
11404
11405
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011406tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11407 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
11408 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11409 no | yes | yes | no
11410 Arguments :
11411 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11412 below.
11413
11414 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11415
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011416 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011417 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
11418 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
11419 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
11420 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
11421 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
11422 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
11423 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011424 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011425 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
11426 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
11427 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
11428 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
11429 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
11430 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
11431 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
11432 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
11433 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
11434 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
11435 instead.
11436
11437 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11438 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11439 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
11440 rules which may be inserted.
11441
11442 Several types of actions are supported :
11443 - accept : the request is accepted
11444 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11445 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
11446 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011447 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011448 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011449 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011450 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011451 - silent-drop
11452
11453 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
11454 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
11455 sections for a complete description.
11456
11457 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11458 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11459 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
11460
11461 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
11462 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
11463 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
11464 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
11465 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
11466
11467 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11468 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11469
11470 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11471 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
11472 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
11473
11474 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
11475 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
11476 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11477
11478 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
11479 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11480 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
11481
11482 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
11483 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11484 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
11485
11486 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11487
11488 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
11489
11490
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011491tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
11492 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
11493 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11494 no | no | yes | yes
11495 Arguments :
11496 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11497 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11498 as explained at the top of this document.
11499
11500 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
11501
11502
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011503timeout check <timeout>
11504 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
11505 established.
11506
11507 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11508 yes | no | yes | yes
11509 Arguments:
11510 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11511 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11512 as explained at the top of this document.
11513
11514 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
11515 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011516 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011517 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010011518 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
11519 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
11520 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011521
11522 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
11523 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
11524
11525 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
11526 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010011527 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011528
11529 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11530 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11531 forget about it.
11532
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010011533 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
11534 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011535
11536
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011537timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011538 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
11539 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11540 yes | yes | yes | no
11541 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011542 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011543 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11544 as explained at the top of this document.
11545
11546 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
11547 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
11548 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010011549 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
11550 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
11551 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
11552 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011553 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
11554 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
11555 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011556 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011557 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011558 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
11559 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011560 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
11561 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011562
11563 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
11564 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11565 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11566 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011567 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011568 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11569
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011570 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010011571
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011572 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011573
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011574
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011575timeout client-fin <timeout>
11576 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
11577 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11578 yes | yes | yes | no
11579 Arguments :
11580 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11581 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11582 as explained at the top of this document.
11583
11584 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
11585 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11586 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
11587 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
11588 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
11589 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
11590 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010011591 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
11592 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
11593 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011594
11595 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
11596 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11597 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
11598
11599 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
11600
11601
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011602timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011603 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
11604 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11605 yes | no | yes | yes
11606 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011607 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011608 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11609 as explained at the top of this document.
11610
11611 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011612 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011613 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011614 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011615 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
11616 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011617
11618 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11619 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11620 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11621 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011622 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011623 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11624
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011625 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011626
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011627
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011628timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
11629 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
11630 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11631 yes | yes | yes | yes
11632 Arguments :
11633 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11634 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11635 as explained at the top of this document.
11636
11637 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
11638 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
11639 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
11640 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
11641 once the request has started to present itself.
11642
11643 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
11644 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
11645 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
11646 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
11647 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
11648
11649 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
11650 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
11651 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
11652 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
11653
11654 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
11655 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011656 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011657 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
11658 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020011659 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011660
11661 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
11662 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
11663 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
11664 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
11665
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011666 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
11667 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010011668 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
11669
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011670 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
11671
11672
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011673timeout http-request <timeout>
11674 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
11675 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011676 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011677 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011678 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011679 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11680 as explained at the top of this document.
11681
11682 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
11683 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
11684 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
11685 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
11686 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
11687 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
11688 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020011689 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
11690 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
11691 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
11692 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011693 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011694 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
11695 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011696
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011697 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
11698 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
11699 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
11700 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
11701 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011702 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011703
11704 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
11705 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011706 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011707 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
11708 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
11709
11710 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011711 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
11712 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
11713 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011714
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011715 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011716 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011717
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011718
11719timeout queue <timeout>
11720 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
11721 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11722 yes | no | yes | yes
11723 Arguments :
11724 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11725 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11726 as explained at the top of this document.
11727
11728 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
11729 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
11730 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
11731 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
11732 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
11733
11734 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
11735 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
11736 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
11737 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
11738
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011739 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011740
11741
11742timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011743 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
11744 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11745 yes | no | yes | yes
11746 Arguments :
11747 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11748 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11749 as explained at the top of this document.
11750
11751 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11752 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
11753 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
11754 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
11755 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
11756 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
11757 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
11758
11759 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11760 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11761 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
11762 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
11763 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011764 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011765 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011766 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
11767 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011768 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
11769 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011770
11771 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11772 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11773 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11774 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011775 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011776 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11777
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011778 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011779
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011780
11781timeout server-fin <timeout>
11782 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
11783 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11784 yes | no | yes | yes
11785 Arguments :
11786 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11787 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11788 as explained at the top of this document.
11789
11790 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11791 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11792 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
11793 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
11794 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
11795 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
11796 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
11797 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
11798 situations, it should not be needed.
11799
11800 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11801 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11802 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
11803
11804 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
11805
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011806
11807timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011808 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011809 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11810 yes | yes | yes | yes
11811 Arguments :
11812 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
11813 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11814 as explained at the top of this document.
11815
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020011816 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
11817 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
11818 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011819
11820 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11821 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11822 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
11823 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011824 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011825
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011826 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011827
11828
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011829timeout tunnel <timeout>
11830 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
11831 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11832 yes | no | yes | yes
11833 Arguments :
11834 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11835 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11836 as explained at the top of this document.
11837
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011838 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011839 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
11840 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
11841 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011842 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
11843 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011844 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
11845 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
11846 specified.
11847
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011848 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
11849 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
11850 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
11851 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
11852 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
11853 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
11854 state.
11855
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011856 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11857 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11858 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
11859 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011860 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011861
11862 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11863 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11864 forget about it.
11865
11866 Example :
11867 defaults http
11868 option http-server-close
11869 timeout connect 5s
11870 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011871 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011872 timeout server 30s
11873 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
11874
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011875 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011876
11877
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011878transparent (deprecated)
11879 Enable client-side transparent proxying
11880 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010011881 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011882 Arguments : none
11883
11884 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
11885 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
11886 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
11887 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
11888 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
11889 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
11890 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
11891 appropriate server.
11892
11893 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
11894
11895 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
11896 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
11897
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011898 See also: "option transparent"
11899
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011900unique-id-format <string>
11901 Generate a unique ID for each request.
11902 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11903 yes | yes | yes | no
11904 Arguments :
11905 <string> is a log-format string.
11906
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011907 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
11908 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
11909 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
11910 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011911
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011912 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
11913 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
11914 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
11915 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
11916 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
11917 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
11918 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
11919 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011920
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011921 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
11922 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011923
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011924 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011925
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011926 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011927
11928 will generate:
11929
11930 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11931
11932 See also: "unique-id-header"
11933
11934unique-id-header <name>
11935 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
11936 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11937 yes | yes | yes | no
11938 Arguments :
11939 <name> is the name of the header.
11940
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011941 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
11942 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011943
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011944 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011945
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011946 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011947 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
11948
11949 will generate:
11950
11951 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11952
11953 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011954
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011955use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011956 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011957 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11958 no | yes | yes | no
11959 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011960 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
11961 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011962
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011963 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
11964 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011965
11966 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
11967 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
11968 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011969 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011970 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011971 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
11972 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011973
11974 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
11975 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
11976 assign the backend.
11977
11978 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
11979 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11980 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
11981 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
11982 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
11983 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
11984
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011985 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011986 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011987 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
11988 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
11989 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
11990
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011991 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
11992 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
11993 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
11994 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
11995 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
11996 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
11997 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
11998 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
11999 cannot be forced from the request.
12000
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012001 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012002 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
12003 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
12004
12005 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
12006 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012007
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012008use-fcgi-app <name>
12009 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
12010 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12011 no | no | yes | yes
12012 Arguments :
12013 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
12014
12015 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012016
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012017use-server <server> if <condition>
12018use-server <server> unless <condition>
12019 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
12020 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12021 no | no | yes | yes
12022 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012023 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
12024 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012025
12026 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
12027
12028 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
12029 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
12030 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
12031
12032 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
12033 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
12034 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
12035 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
12036 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
12037 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
12038 matches will assign the server.
12039
12040 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
12041 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
12042 with the next rules until one matches.
12043
12044 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
12045 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12046 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
12047 according to other persistence mechanisms.
12048
12049 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
12050 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
12051 stripped.
12052
12053 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
12054 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
12055 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
12056 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
12057
12058 Example :
12059 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
12060 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
12061 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
12062 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
12063 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
12064 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000012065 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012066 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
12067 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
12068
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012069 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
12070 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
12071 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
12072 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050012073 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012074 and we fall back to load balancing.
12075
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012076 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012077
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012078
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100120795. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012080--------------------------
12081
12082The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
12083depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
12084settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
12085written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
12086described in this section.
12087
12088
120895.1. Bind options
12090-----------------
12091
12092The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
12093as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
12094no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
12095parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
12096while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
12097provided immediately after the setting name.
12098
12099The currently supported settings are the following ones.
12100
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012101accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
12102 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
12103 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
12104 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
12105 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
12106 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
12107 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
12108 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
12109 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
12110 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010012111 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
12112 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
12113 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012114
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012115accept-proxy
12116 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020012117 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
12118 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012119 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
12120 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
12121 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
12122 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012123 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012124 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
12125 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012126 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
12127 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012128
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012129allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010012130 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012131 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012132 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012133 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
12134 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012135
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012136alpn <protocols>
12137 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12138 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12139 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012140 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012141 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012142 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
12143 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12144 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
12145 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
12146 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
12147 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
12148 preference, like below :
12149
12150 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012151
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012152backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010012153 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012154 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
12155
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010012156curves <curves>
12157 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12158 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
12159 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
12160 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
12161 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
12162 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
12163
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012164ecdhe <named curve>
12165 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010012166 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
12167 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012168
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012169ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012170 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12171 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12172 client's certificate.
12173
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012174ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
12175 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12176 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
12177 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
12178 error is ignored.
12179
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012180ca-sign-file <cafile>
12181 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12182 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
12183 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
12184 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12185 'generate-certificates' for details.
12186
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000012187ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012188 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
12189 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
12190 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12191 'generate-certificates' for details.
12192
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012193ca-verify-file <cafile>
12194 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
12195 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
12196 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
12197 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
12198 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
12199
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012200ciphers <ciphers>
12201 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12202 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000012203 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012204 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012205 information and recommendations see e.g.
12206 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12207 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12208 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
12209
12210ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12211 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12212 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
12213 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
12214 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012215 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
12216 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012217
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012218crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012219 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12220 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12221 to verify client's certificate.
12222
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012223crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012224 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12225 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
12226 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
12227 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
12228 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010012229 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
12230 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012231
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010012232 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
12233 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
12234
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012235 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
12236 are loaded.
12237
12238 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010012239 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
12240 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
12241 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
12242 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
12243 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
12244 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
12245 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012246 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012247
12248 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
12249 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
12250 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
12251 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010012252 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
12253 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012254
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020012255 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012256
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012257 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012258 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012259 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
12260 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012261 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
12262 clients).
12263
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020012264 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
12265 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
12266 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
12267 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
12268 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
12269 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
12270 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
12271 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
12272 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
12273 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
12274 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
12275 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
12276 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
12277
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012278 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
12279 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
12280 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
12281 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
12282 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
12283
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012284 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
12285 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
12286 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
12287 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012288
12289 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
12290 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
12291 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
12292 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
12293 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
12294 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
12295 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
12296 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
12297 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
12298
12299 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
12300
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012301 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012302 a cert bundle.
12303
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012304 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012305 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
12306 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
12307 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
12308 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
12309 provide multi-cert support.
12310
12311 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
12312
12313 Filename | CN | SAN
12314 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
12315 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012316 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012317 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
12318 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
12319
12320 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
12321 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
12322 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
12323 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020012324 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
12325 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
12326 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012327
12328 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
12329 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
12330
12331 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
12332 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
12333 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
12334
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012335crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012336 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012337 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012338 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012339 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012340
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012341crt-list <file>
12342 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012343 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
12344 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012345
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012346 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
12347
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020012348 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
12349 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
12350 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
12351 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
12352 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012353
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020012354 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
12355 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
12356 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
12357 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
12358 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
12359 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
12360 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
12361 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012362
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012363 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020012364 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020012365 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
12366 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
12367 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012368
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012369 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
12370
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012371 crt-list file example:
12372 cert1.pem
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012373 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012374 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012375 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012376 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012377
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012378defer-accept
12379 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12380 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
12381 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012382 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012383 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
12384 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
12385 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
12386 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
12387 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
12388 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
12389 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
12390
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012391expose-fd listeners
12392 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
12393 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020012394 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
12395 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012396 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012397
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012398force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012399 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012400 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012401 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012402 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012403
12404force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012405 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012406 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012407 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012408
12409force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012410 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012411 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012412 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012413
12414force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012415 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012416 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012417 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012418
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012419force-tlsv13
12420 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
12421 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012422 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012423
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012424generate-certificates
12425 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12426 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
12427 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
12428 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
12429 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
12430 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
12431 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
12432 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
12433 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
12434 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
12435 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
12436
12437 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
12438 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012439 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012440 certificate is used many times.
12441
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012442gid <gid>
12443 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
12444 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12445 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
12446 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
12447 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12448
12449group <group>
12450 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
12451 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
12452 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
12453 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
12454 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12455
12456id <id>
12457 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
12458 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
12459 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
12460 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
12461
12462interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010012463 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
12464 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
12465 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
12466 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
12467 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
12468 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010012469 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
12470 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
12471 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
12472 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
12473 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
12474 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012475
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012476level <level>
12477 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
12478 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
12479 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012480 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012481 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
12482 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
12483 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012484 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012485 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012486 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012487 all counters).
12488
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020012489severity-output <format>
12490 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
12491 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
12492 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
12493 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
12494 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
12495 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
12496 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
12497 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
12498 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
12499 rfc5424 convention.
12500
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012501maxconn <maxconn>
12502 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
12503 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
12504 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
12505 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
12506 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
12507 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
12508 eat all memory.
12509
12510mode <mode>
12511 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
12512 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
12513 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
12514 UNIX sockets.
12515
12516mss <maxseg>
12517 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
12518 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
12519 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
12520 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
12521 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
12522 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
12523 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
12524 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
12525 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
12526 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
12527 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
12528
12529name <name>
12530 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
12531 page.
12532
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012533namespace <name>
12534 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12535 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
12536 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12537 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12538
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012539nice <nice>
12540 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
12541 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
12542 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
12543 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
12544 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
12545 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
12546 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
12547 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
12548 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
12549 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
12550 one for an RDP socket.
12551
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020012552no-ca-names
12553 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12554 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012555 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020012556
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012557no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012558 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012559 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012560 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012561 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012562 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
12563 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012564
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020012565no-tls-tickets
12566 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12567 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12568 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012569 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
12570 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012571 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12572 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12573 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020012574
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012575no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012576 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012577 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012578 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012579 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012580 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12581 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012582
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012583no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012584 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012585 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012586 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012587 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012588 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12589 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012590
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012591no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012592 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012593 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012594 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012595 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012596 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12597 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012598
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012599no-tlsv13
12600 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12601 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
12602 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
12603 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012604 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12605 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012606
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020012607npn <protocols>
12608 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12609 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12610 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012611 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012612 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012613 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12614 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
12615 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
12616 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
12617 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020012618
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000012619prefer-client-ciphers
12620 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
12621 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
12622 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020012623 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
12624 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
12625 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000012626
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012627process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010012628 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012629 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012630 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012631 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
12632 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
12633 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
12634 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012635 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010012636 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
12637 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
12638 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
12639 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
12640 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012641
12642 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
12643
12644 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
12645 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
12646 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
12647 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
12648 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
12649 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
12650 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
12651 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020012652
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012653proto <name>
12654 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
12655 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
12656 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
12657 in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040012658 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012659 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080012660 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012661 h2" on the bind line.
12662
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012663ssl
12664 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012665 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012666 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
12667 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020012668 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
12669 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012670
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012671ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12672 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020012673 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
12674 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
12675 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012676 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12677
12678ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020012679 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
12680 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
12681 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
12682 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012683
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010012684strict-sni
12685 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
12686 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
12687 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
12688 See the "crt" option for more information.
12689
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012690tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012691 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012692 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
12693 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012694 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012695 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
12696 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
12697 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
12698 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
12699 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
12700 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
12701 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12702
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012703tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010012704 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012705 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
12706 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
12707 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
12708 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
12709 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
12710 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
12711 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020012712 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
12713 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
12714 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012715
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012716tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
12717 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010012718 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
12719 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
12720 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
12721 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
12722 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
12723 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
12724 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
12725 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
12726 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
12727 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012728 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
12729 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
12730
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012731transparent
12732 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12733 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
12734 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
12735 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
12736 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
12737 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
12738 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
12739 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
12740 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
12741 so check for support with your vendor.
12742
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012743v4v6
12744 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12745 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
12746 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
12747 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012748 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012749
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012750v6only
12751 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12752 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
12753 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012754 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
12755 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012756
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012757uid <uid>
12758 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
12759 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12760 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
12761 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
12762 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12763
12764user <user>
12765 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
12766 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12767 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
12768 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
12769 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12770
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012771verify [none|optional|required]
12772 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
12773 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
12774 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
12775 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
12776 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012777 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
12778 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
12779 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
12780 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012781
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200127825.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010012783------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012784
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012785The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
12786which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
12787arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
12788settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
12789after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
12790Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
12791address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012792
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012793 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012794 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012795
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012796Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
12797keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
12798
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012799The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012800
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012801addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012802 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010012803 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
12804 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
12805 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
12806 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
12807 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012808
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012809agent-check
12810 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012811 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010012812 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
12813 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
12814 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012815
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012816 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012817 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020012818 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
12819 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
12820 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012821
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012822 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
12823 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
12824 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
12825 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
12826 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020012827
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012828 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012829 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012830
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012831 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12832 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
12833 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012834
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012835 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12836 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
12837 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012838
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012839 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
12840 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
12841 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
12842 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
12843 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012844 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012845 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012846
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012847 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
12848 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012849
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012850 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
12851 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
12852 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
12853 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
12854 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
12855 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
12856 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
12857 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
12858 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012859
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012860 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
12861 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012862 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
12863 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
12864 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010012865 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012866
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012867 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012868 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012869
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070012870agent-send <string>
12871 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
12872 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
12873 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
12874 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
12875 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
12876
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012877agent-inter <delay>
12878 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
12879 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12880
12881 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
12882 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
12883 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
12884 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
12885 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12886 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12887 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12888 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12889 of backends use the same servers.
12890
12891 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
12892
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010012893agent-addr <addr>
12894 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
12895
12896 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
12897 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
12898 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
12899 hostname, it will be resolved.
12900
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012901agent-port <port>
12902 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
12903
12904 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
12905
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012906allow-0rtt
12907 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020012908 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
12909 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012910
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012911alpn <protocols>
12912 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12913 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12914 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012915 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012916 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
12917 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
12918 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12919 now obsolete NPN extension.
12920 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
12921 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
12922
12923 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
12924
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012925backup
12926 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
12927 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
12928 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
12929 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012930 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
12931 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012932
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012933ca-file <cafile>
12934 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12935 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12936 server's certificate.
12937
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012938check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020012939 This option enables health checks on a server:
12940 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
12941 considered available.
12942 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
12943 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
12944 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
12945 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
12946 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
12947 set.
12948 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
12949 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
12950 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
12951 exchanges succeed.
12952
12953 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
12954 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
12955 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
12956 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
12957 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050012958 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020012959 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
12960
12961 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
12962 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
12963
12964 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
12965 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
12966
12967 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
12968 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
12969 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
12970 available.
12971
12972 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
12973 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
12974 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
12975
12976 Example:
12977 # simple tcp check
12978 backend foo
12979 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
12980 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
12981 backend foo
12982 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
12983 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
12984 backend foo
12985 option tcp-check
12986 tcp-check connect
12987 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012988
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020012989check-send-proxy
12990 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
12991 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
12992 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
12993 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
12994 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
12995 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
12996 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
12997
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010012998check-alpn <protocols>
12999 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
13000 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
13001 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
13002
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013003check-proto <name>
13004 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
13005 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
13006 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
13007 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013008 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013009 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
13010 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
13011
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013012check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013013 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013014 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
13015 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013016
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013017check-ssl
13018 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
13019 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
13020 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
13021 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013022 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013023 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
13024 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013025 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013026 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
13027 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013028
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013029check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013030 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013031 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
13032 for normal traffic.
13033
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013034ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013035 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
13036 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
13037 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013038 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
13039 information and recommendations see e.g.
13040 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13041 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13042 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013043
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013044ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13045 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13046 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
13047 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
13048 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013049 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
13050 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
13051 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013052
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013053cookie <value>
13054 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
13055 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
13056 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
13057 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
13058 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
13059 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
13060 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
13061
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013062crl-file <crlfile>
13063 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13064 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
13065 to verify server's certificate.
13066
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020013067crt <cert>
13068 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13069 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
13070 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
13071 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
13072 certificate request.
13073
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013074disabled
13075 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
13076 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
13077 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
13078 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
13079 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013080 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013081
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013082enabled
13083 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
13084 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
13085 default value.
13086 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
13087 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013088
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013089error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010013090 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
13091 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
13092 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013093
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013094 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013095
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013096fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013097 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
13098 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
13099 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
13100
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013101force-sslv3
13102 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13103 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013104 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013105 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013106
13107force-tlsv10
13108 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013109 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013110 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013111
13112force-tlsv11
13113 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013114 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013115 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013116
13117force-tlsv12
13118 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013119 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013120 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013121
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013122force-tlsv13
13123 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13124 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013125 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013126
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013127id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020013128 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
13129 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
13130 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013131
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013132init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
13133 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
13134 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013135 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013136 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
13137 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
13138 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
13139 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
13140 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
13141 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
13142 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
13143 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
13144 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013145 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013146 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
13147 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
13148 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
13149 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
13150 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
13151 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013152 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013153
13154 Example:
13155 defaults
13156 # never fail on address resolution
13157 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
13158
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013159inter <delay>
13160fastinter <delay>
13161downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013162 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
13163 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13164 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
13165 between checks depending on the server state :
13166
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020013167 Server state | Interval used
13168 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13169 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
13170 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13171 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
13172 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
13173 or yet unchecked. |
13174 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13175 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
13176 | "inter" otherwise.
13177 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013178
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013179 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
13180 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
13181 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
13182 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013183 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13184 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13185 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13186 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13187 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013188
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020013189log-proto <logproto>
13190 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
13191 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
13192 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
13193 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
13194
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013195maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013196 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
13197 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013198 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
13199 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013200 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
13201 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
13202 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
13203 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
13204
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013205 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
13206 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
13207 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
13208 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
13209 than 50 concurrent requests.
13210
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013211maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013212 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
13213 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
13214 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
13215 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
13216 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
13217 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
13218 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
13219
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010013220max-reuse <count>
13221 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
13222 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
13223 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
13224 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
13225 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
13226 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
13227 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
13228 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
13229
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013230minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013231 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
13232 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
13233 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
13234 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
13235 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
13236 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013237 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013238 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013239
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013240namespace <name>
13241 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13242 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
13243 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13244 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13245
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013246no-agent-check
13247 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
13248 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13249 default value.
13250 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13251 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
13252
13253no-backup
13254 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
13255 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13256 default value.
13257 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13258 "default-server" "backup" setting.
13259
13260no-check
13261 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
13262 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13263 default value.
13264 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13265 "default-server" "check" setting.
13266
13267no-check-ssl
13268 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
13269 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13270 default value.
13271 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13272 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
13273
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013274no-send-proxy
13275 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
13276 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13277 default value.
13278 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13279 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
13280
13281no-send-proxy-v2
13282 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
13283 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13284 default value.
13285 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13286 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
13287
13288no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
13289 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
13290 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13291 default value.
13292 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13293 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
13294
13295no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13296 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
13297 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13298 default value.
13299 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13300 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
13301
13302no-ssl
13303 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
13304 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13305 default value.
13306 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13307 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
13308
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010013309no-ssl-reuse
13310 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
13311 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
13312 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
13313 and for paranoid users.
13314
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013315no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013316 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13317 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013318 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013319
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013320 Supported in default-server: No
13321
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013322no-tls-tickets
13323 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13324 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13325 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013326 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
13327 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013328 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13329 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13330 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013331 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013332
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013333no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013334 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013335 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13336 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013337 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13338 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013339 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013340
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013341 Supported in default-server: No
13342
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013343no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013344 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013345 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13346 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013347 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13348 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013349 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013350
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013351 Supported in default-server: No
13352
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013353no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013354 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013355 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13356 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013357 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13358 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013359 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013360
13361 Supported in default-server: No
13362
13363no-tlsv13
13364 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13365 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13366 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
13367 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13368 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013369 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013370
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013371 Supported in default-server: No
13372
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013373no-verifyhost
13374 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
13375 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13376 default value.
13377 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13378 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013379
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020013380no-tfo
13381 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
13382 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13383 default value.
13384 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13385 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
13386
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090013387non-stick
13388 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
13389 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
13390 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
13391
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013392npn <protocols>
13393 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13394 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13395 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013396 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013397 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
13398 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13399 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
13400
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013401observe <mode>
13402 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
13403 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
13404 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
13405 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
13406 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
13407 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010013408 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013409
13410 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
13411
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013412on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013413 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
13414 Currently, four modes are available:
13415 - fastinter: force fastinter
13416 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
13417 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
13418 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
13419 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
13420
13421 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
13422
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013423on-marked-down <action>
13424 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
13425 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013426 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
13427 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
13428 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
13429 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
13430 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
13431 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
13432 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
13433 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013434
13435 Actions are disabled by default
13436
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013437on-marked-up <action>
13438 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
13439 Currently one action is available:
13440 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
13441 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
13442 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
13443 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013444 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
13445 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013446 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
13447 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
13448
13449 Actions are disabled by default
13450
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020013451pool-low-conn <max>
13452 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
13453 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
13454 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
13455 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
13456 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
13457 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
13458 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
13459 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
13460 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
13461 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
13462 applying to "http-reuse".
13463
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010013464pool-max-conn <max>
13465 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
13466 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
13467 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
13468 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
13469 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
13470 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
13471
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013472pool-purge-delay <delay>
13473 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010013474 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020013475 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013476
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013477port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013478 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
13479 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
13480 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
13481 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
13482 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
13483 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
13484
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013485proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013486 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
13487 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
13488 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
13489 reported in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013490 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013491 protocol for all connections established to this server.
13492
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013493redir <prefix>
13494 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
13495 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
13496 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
13497 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
13498 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
13499 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
13500 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
13501 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013502 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013503 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013504 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
13505 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
13506 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
13507 loop between the client and HAProxy!
13508
13509 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
13510
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013511rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013512 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
13513 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
13514 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
13515
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020013516resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
13517 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
13518 server.
13519
13520 Available options:
13521
13522 * allow-dup-ip
13523 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
13524 resolution at runtime is in operation.
13525 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
13526 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
13527 For such case, simply enable this option.
13528 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
13529
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050013530 * ignore-weight
13531 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
13532 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
13533 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
13534
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020013535 * prevent-dup-ip
13536 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
13537 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
13538 same fqdn.
13539 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
13540
13541 Example:
13542 backend b_myapp
13543 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
13544 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
13545 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
13546
13547 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
13548 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
13549 it
13550 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
13551 different address
13552
13553 Default value: not set
13554
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013555resolve-prefer <family>
13556 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
13557 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
13558 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
13559 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
13560
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020013561 Default value: ipv6
13562
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013563 Example:
13564
13565 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013566
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013567resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013568 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013569 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013570 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013571 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
13572 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013573 configured network, another address is selected.
13574
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013575 Example:
13576
13577 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013578
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013579resolvers <id>
13580 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
13581 hostname.
13582
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013583 Example:
13584
13585 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013586
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013587 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013588
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010013589send-proxy
13590 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
13591 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
13592 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
13593 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013594 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
13595 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
13596 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
13597 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
13598 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
13599 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
13600 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
13601 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
13602 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
13603 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013604 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
13605 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010013606
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013607send-proxy-v2
13608 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
13609 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13610 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13611 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020013612 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
13613 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
13614 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
13615 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013616
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010013617proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010013618 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
13619 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
13620
13621 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
13622 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
13623 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
13624 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
13625 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
13626 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
13627 connection is supported).
13628 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
13629 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
13630 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
13631 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
13632 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
13633 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
13634 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010013635
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013636send-proxy-v2-ssl
13637 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
13638 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13639 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13640 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
13641 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
13642 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
13643 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013644 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
13645 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013646
13647send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13648 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
13649 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13650 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13651 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
13652 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
13653 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
13654 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
13655 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013656 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
13657 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013658
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013659slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013660 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
13661 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
13662 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
13663 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
13664 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
13665 parameters :
13666
13667 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
13668 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
13669
13670 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
13671 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
13672 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
13673 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
13674
13675 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
13676 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
13677 seen as failed.
13678
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020013679sni <expression>
13680 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
13681 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
13682 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
13683 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020013684 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
13685 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013686 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010013687 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
13688 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020013689
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013690source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020013691source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013692source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013693 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
13694 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
13695 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
13696 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
13697
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013698 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
13699 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
13700 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
13701 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
13702 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
13703 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
13704 server.
13705
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000013706 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
13707 specifying the source address without port(s).
13708
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013709ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020013710 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
13711 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
13712 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
13713 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
13714 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
13715 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013716 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
13717 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013718
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013719ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13720 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
13721 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
13722 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13723
13724ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13725 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
13726 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
13727 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
13728
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013729ssl-reuse
13730 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
13731 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13732 default value.
13733 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13734 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
13735
13736stick
13737 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
13738 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13739 default value.
13740 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13741 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013742
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013743socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013744 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013745 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
13746 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
13747
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020013748tcp-ut <delay>
13749 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
13750 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
13751 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013752 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020013753 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
13754 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
13755 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
13756 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
13757 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
13758 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
13759 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
13760 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
13761 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13762
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010013763tfo
13764 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
13765 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
13766 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
13767 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
13768 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020013769 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010013770
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013771track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020013772 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
13773 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
13774 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
13775 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013776 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
13777
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013778tls-tickets
13779 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
13780 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13781 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013782 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13783 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13784 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013785 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010013786 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013787
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013788verify [none|required]
13789 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010013790 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013791 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
13792 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013793 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013794 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
13795 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
13796 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
13797 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
13798 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
13799 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
13800 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
13801 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013802
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070013803verifyhost <hostname>
13804 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013805 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
13806 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
13807 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
13808 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
13809 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
13810 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
13811 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
13812 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070013813
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013814weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013815 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
13816 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
13817 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020013818 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
13819 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
13820 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
13821 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
13822 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
13823 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013824
13825
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200138265.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
13827-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013828
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013829HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
13830using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
13831configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013832This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
13833can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
13834workload.
13835This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
13836resolution at run time.
13837Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
13838carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
13839
13840
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200138415.3.1. Global overview
13842----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013843
13844As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
13845different steps of the process life:
13846
13847 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
13848 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
13849 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
13850
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013851 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
13852 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013853
13854A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
13855 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
13856 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
13857 resolution to know this new IP.
13858
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013859When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013860HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013861SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
13862from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
13863will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
13864will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020013865
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013866A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013867 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013868 first valid response.
13869
13870 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
13871 servers return an error.
13872
13873
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200138745.3.2. The resolvers section
13875----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013876
13877This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013878HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
13879contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013880
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013881When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
13882uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
13883is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
13884answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
13885
13886When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013887used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013888
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013889 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
13890 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
13891 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013892
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013893 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
13894 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013895
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013896 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
13897 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
13898 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013899
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013900For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
13901following scenarios are possible:
13902
13903 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
13904 ignored
13905
13906 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
13907 applied
13908
13909 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
13910 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
13911
13912 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
13913 retries the query with a new type
13914
13915 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
13916 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013917
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013918As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
13919a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013920<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013921
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013922
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013923resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013924 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013925
13926A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
13927
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013928accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013929 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013930 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013931 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
13932 by RFC 6891)
13933
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020013934 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
13935
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013936nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
13937 DNS server description:
13938 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
13939 <ip> : IP address of the server
13940 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
13941
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013942parse-resolv-conf
13943 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
13944 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
13945 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
13946
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013947hold <status> <period>
13948 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
13949 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013950 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013951 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013952 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
13953 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13954 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
13955
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020013956 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013957
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013958resolve_retries <nb>
13959 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
13960 giving up.
13961 Default value: 3
13962
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013963 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
13964 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
13965 type.
13966
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013967timeout <event> <time>
13968 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
13969 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
13970 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013971 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
13972 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013973 Default value: 1s
13974 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013975 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013976 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013977 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13978 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
13979
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013980 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013981
13982 resolvers mydns
13983 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
13984 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013985 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013986 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013987 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013988 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013989 hold other 30s
13990 hold refused 30s
13991 hold nx 30s
13992 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013993 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013994 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013995
13996
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200139976. Cache
13998---------
13999
14000HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
14001(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
14002RAM.
14003
14004The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
14005this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
14006
14007If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
14008independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
14009when we try to allocate a new one.
14010
14011The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
14012
14013It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
14014"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
14015for more details.
14016
14017When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
14018replaced by "<CACHE>".
14019
14020
140216.1. Limitation
14022----------------
14023
14024The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
14025
14026- If the response is not a 200
14027- If the response contains a Vary header
14028- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
14029- If the response is not cacheable
14030
14031- If the request is not a GET
14032- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
14033- If the request contains an Authorization header
14034
14035
140366.2. Setup
14037-----------
14038
14039To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
14040the corresponding http-request and response actions.
14041
14042
140436.2.1. Cache section
14044---------------------
14045
14046cache <name>
14047 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
14048 size of cache is mandatory.
14049
14050total-max-size <megabytes>
14051 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
14052 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
14053
14054max-object-size <bytes>
14055 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
14056 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
14057 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
14058
14059max-age <seconds>
14060 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
14061 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
14062 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
14063 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
14064 default.
14065
14066
140676.2.2. Proxy section
14068---------------------
14069
14070http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14071 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
14072 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
14073 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
14074 after this one.
14075
14076http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14077 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
14078 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
14079 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
14080 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
14081
14082
14083Example:
14084
14085 backend bck1
14086 mode http
14087
14088 http-request cache-use foobar
14089 http-response cache-store foobar
14090 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
14091
14092 cache foobar
14093 total-max-size 4
14094 max-age 240
14095
14096
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200140977. Using ACLs and fetching samples
14098----------------------------------
14099
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014100HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014101client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
14102The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
14103these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
14104but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
14105data called patterns.
14106
14107
141087.1. ACL basics
14109---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014110
14111The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
14112content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
14113from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
14114simple :
14115
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014116 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014117 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014118 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
14119 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014120
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014121The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
14122adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014123
14124In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
14125
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014126 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014127
14128This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
14129Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
14130and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014131an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
14132conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
14133as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
14134are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014135
14136ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
14137'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
14138which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
14139
14140There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
14141performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
14142
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014143The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
14144specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
14145this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014146methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
14147ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014148
14149Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
14150 - boolean
14151 - integer (signed or unsigned)
14152 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
14153 - string
14154 - data block
14155
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014156Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
14157converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
14158would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
14159The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
14160which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
14161
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014162Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
14163keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
14164fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
14165which are summarized in the table below :
14166
14167 +---------------------+-----------------+
14168 | Sample or converter | Default |
14169 | output type | matching method |
14170 +---------------------+-----------------+
14171 | boolean | bool |
14172 +---------------------+-----------------+
14173 | integer | int |
14174 +---------------------+-----------------+
14175 | ip | ip |
14176 +---------------------+-----------------+
14177 | string | str |
14178 +---------------------+-----------------+
14179 | binary | none, use "-m" |
14180 +---------------------+-----------------+
14181
14182Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
14183matching method, see below.
14184
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014185The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
14186 - boolean
14187 - integer or integer range
14188 - IP address / network
14189 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
14190 - regular expression
14191 - hex block
14192
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014193The following ACL flags are currently supported :
14194
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014195 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
14196 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014197 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014198 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014199 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014200 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014201 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
14202
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014203The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
14204read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
14205if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
14206lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
14207will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
14208beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
14209a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
14210lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
14211exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
14212
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014213The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
14214parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
14215ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
14216a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
14217check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
14218
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014219The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
14220socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
14221file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
14222
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014223Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
14224loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
14225
14226 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
14227
14228In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
14229the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
14230case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
14231as well.
14232
14233The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
14234sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
14235do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
14236methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
14237is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014238obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014239followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
14240default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
14241that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
14242string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
14243
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014244The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
14245By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
14246string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
14247resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
14248server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014249waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014250flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
14251function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
14252
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014253There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
14254sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
14255be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014256
14257 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
14258 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014259 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
14260 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
14261 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
14262 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014263
14264 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
14265 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014266 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014267
14268 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014269 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014270
14271 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014272 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014273
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014274 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014275 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
14276
14277 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
14278 binary or string samples.
14279
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014280 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
14281 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014282
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014283 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
14284 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
14285 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014286
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014287 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
14288 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014289
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014290 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
14291 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014292
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014293 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
14294 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014295
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014296 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
14297 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014298 This may be used with binary or string samples.
14299
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014300 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
14301 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
14302 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014303
14304For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
14305request, it is possible to do :
14306
14307 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
14308
14309In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
14310buffer, one would use the following acl :
14311
14312 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
14313
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014314On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
14315possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
14316
14317 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
14318
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014319All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
14320criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
14321method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
14322to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
14323criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
14324the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014325
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014326If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014327the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
14328For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014329
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014330 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
14331 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
14332 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
14333 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014334
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014335
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014336The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
14337types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
14338combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
14339brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
14340default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014341
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014342 +-------------------------------------------------+
14343 | Input sample type |
14344 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014345 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014346 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14347 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
14348 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014349 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014350 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014351 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014352 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014353 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014354 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014355 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014356 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014357 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014358 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014359 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014360 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014361 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014362 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014363 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014364 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014365 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014366 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014367 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014368 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014369 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014370 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14371 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
14372 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014373
14374
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200143757.1.1. Matching booleans
14376------------------------
14377
14378In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
14379Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
14380When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
14381that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
14382
14383Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
14384return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
14385"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
14386
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014387
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200143887.1.2. Matching integers
14389------------------------
14390
14391Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
14392enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
14393to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
14394
14395Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
14396matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
14397lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014398
14399For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
14400unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
14401representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
14402
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014403As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
14404two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
14405instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
14406ranges and operators.
14407
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014408For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014409operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
14410Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
14411of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014412
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014413Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014414
14415 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
14416 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
14417 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
14418 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
14419 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
14420
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014421For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014422
14423 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
14424
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014425This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
14426
14427 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
14428
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014429
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200144307.1.3. Matching strings
14431-----------------------
14432
14433String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
14434different forms :
14435
14436 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014437 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014438
14439 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014440 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014441
14442 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
14443 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14444
14445 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
14446 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14447
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010014448 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014449 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
14450 matches.
14451
14452 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
14453 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
14454 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014455
14456String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
14457exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
14458characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
14459string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
14460to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014461before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014462
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010014463Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
14464(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
14465Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
14466
14467Example:
14468 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
14469 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
14470
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014471
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200144727.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
14473---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014474
14475Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
14476they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
14477possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
14478passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
14479the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014480the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
14481match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014482
14483
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200144847.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
14485-------------------------------------
14486
14487It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
14488not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
14489a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
14490to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
14491digits may be used upper or lower case.
14492
14493Example :
14494 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
14495 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
14496
14497
144987.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
14499---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014500
14501IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
14502netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
14503within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010014504host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014505difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
14506at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
14507does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
14508parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014509
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020014510The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
14511abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
14512
14513 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14514 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
14515 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14516 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
14517 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
14518 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
14519 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
14520 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14521
14522Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
14523192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
14524
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014525IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
14526Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
14527trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
14528IPv6 patterns.
14529
14530HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
14531following situations :
14532 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
14533 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
14534 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
14535 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
14536 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
14537 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
14538 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
14539 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
14540 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
14541 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
14542
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014543
145447.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
14545----------------------------------
14546
14547Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
14548combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
14549
14550 - AND (implicit)
14551 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
14552 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014553
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014554A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014555
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014556 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020014557
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014558Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
14559indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020014560
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014561For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
14562"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
14563requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
14564is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
14565
14566 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014567 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
14568 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
14569 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014570
14571To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
14572and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
14573
14574 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
14575 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
14576 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
14577 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
14578
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014579 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014580 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
14581 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
14582 use_backend www if host_www
14583
14584It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
14585expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
14586be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
14587the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
14588
14589 The following rule :
14590
14591 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014592 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014593
14594 Can also be written that way :
14595
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014596 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014597
14598It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
14599to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
14600simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
14601sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
14602good use is the following :
14603
14604 With named ACLs :
14605
14606 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
14607 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
14608 monitor fail if site_dead
14609
14610 With anonymous ACLs :
14611
14612 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
14613
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014614See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
14615keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014616
14617
146187.3. Fetching samples
14619---------------------
14620
14621Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
14622against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
14623sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
14624ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
14625of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
14626available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
14627
14628This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
14629Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
14630compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
14631deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
14632
14633The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
14634matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
14635method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
14636indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
14637
14638As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
14639when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
14640mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
14641the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
14642ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
14643
14644Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
14645multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
14646when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014647incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
14648are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014649is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
14650all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
14651
14652Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
14653 - name
14654 - name(arg1)
14655 - name(arg1,arg2)
14656
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014657
146587.3.1. Converters
14659-----------------
14660
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014661Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
14662of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
14663is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
14664was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014665has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014666unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
14667
14668These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
14669sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
14670the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014671support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014672
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014673A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
14674support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
14675supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
14676(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
14677bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
14678
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014679The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014680
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001468151d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
14682 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
14683 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
14684 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
14685 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
14686 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
14687
14688 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014689 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
14690 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000014691 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
14692 frontend http-in
14693 bind *:8081
14694 default_backend servers
14695 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
14696 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
14697
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014698add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014699 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014700 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014701 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
14702 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014703 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014704 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14705 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14706 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14707 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014708 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014709 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014710
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010014711aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
14712 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
14713 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
14714 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
14715 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
14716 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
14717 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
14718
14719 Example:
14720 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
14721 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
14722
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014723and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014724 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014725 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014726 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14727 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014728 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014729 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14730 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14731 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14732 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014733 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014734 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014735
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020014736b64dec
14737 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
14738 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
14739
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020014740base64
14741 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014742 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020014743 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
14744
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014745bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014746 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014747 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014748 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014749 presence of a flag).
14750
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010014751bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
14752 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
14753 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014754 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010014755
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014756concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
14757 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
14758 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
14759 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
14760 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
14761 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
14762 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
14763 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
14764 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
14765 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
14766 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014767 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014768 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014769 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
14770 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014771
14772 Example:
14773 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
14774 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
14775 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014776 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014777 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
14778
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014779cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014780 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
14781 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014782
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010014783crc32([<avalanche>])
14784 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
14785 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14786 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14787 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14788 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14789 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
14790 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
14791 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
14792 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
14793 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014794 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
14795
14796crc32c([<avalanche>])
14797 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
14798 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14799 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14800 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
14801 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
14802 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
14803 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
14804 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010014805
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020014806cut_crlf
14807 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
14808 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
14809 updated.
14810
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010014811da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014812 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
14813 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
14814 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
14815 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000014816 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014817 configuration language.
14818
14819 Example:
14820 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020014821 bind *:8881
14822 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000014823 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014824
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010014825debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
14826 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
14827 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
14828 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
14829 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
14830 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
14831 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
14832 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
14833 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
14834 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
14835 printable sample types.
14836
14837 Example:
14838 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020014839
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020014840digest(<algorithm>)
14841 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
14842 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
14843
14844 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
14845 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
14846
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014847div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014848 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
14849 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014850 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014851 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
14852 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014853 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014854 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14855 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14856 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14857 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014858 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014859 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014860
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014861djb2([<avalanche>])
14862 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
14863 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14864 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14865 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14866 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14867 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14868 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014869 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
14870 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014871
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014872even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014873 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014874 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
14875
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014876field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14877 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
14878 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
14879 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
14880 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
14881 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
14882 fields.
14883
14884 Example :
14885 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
14886 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14887 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
14888 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
14889 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010014890
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014891hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014892 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014893 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014894 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014895 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010014896
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020014897hex2i
14898 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014899 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020014900
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020014901htonl
14902 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
14903 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
14904 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
14905 unsigned 32-bit integer.
14906
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020014907hmac(<algorithm>, <key>)
14908 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
14909 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
14910 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
14911 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
14912
14913 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
14914 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
14915
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010014916http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014917 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14918 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014919 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
14920 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
14921 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
14922 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
14923 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
14924 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
14925 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
14926 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014927
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014928in_table(<table>)
14929 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14930 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
14931 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014932 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014933 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
14934
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014935ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
14936 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014937 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014938 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
14939 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
14940 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
14941 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
14942 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014943
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014944json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014945 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014946 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014947 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014948 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
14949 of errors:
14950 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
14951 bytes, ...)
14952 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
14953 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
14954
14955 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
14956 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
14957 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
14958 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
14959 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
14960 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014961 - "ascii" : never fails;
14962 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
14963 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014964 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014965 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014966 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
14967 characters corresponding to the other errors.
14968
14969 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014970 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014971
14972 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014973 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014974 capture request header user-agent len 150
14975 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014976
14977 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
14978 GET / HTTP/1.0
14979 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
14980
14981 Output log:
14982 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
14983
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014984language(<value>[,<default>])
14985 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
14986 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
14987 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
14988 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
14989 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
14990 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
14991 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
14992 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
14993 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014994 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014995 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
14996 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014997
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014998 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014999
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015000 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
15001 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015002
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015003 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
15004 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
15005 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
15006 use_backend spanish if es
15007 use_backend french if fr
15008 use_backend english if en
15009 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015010
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010015011length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010015012 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
15013 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15014 type. The result is of type integer.
15015
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015016lower
15017 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
15018 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15019 type. The result is of type string.
15020
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015021ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
15022 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15023 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
15024 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
15025 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
15026 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
15027 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
15028
15029 Example :
15030
15031 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015032 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015033 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
15034
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020015035ltrim(<chars>)
15036 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
15037 representation of the input sample.
15038
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015039map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15040map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15041map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15042 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
15043 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
15044 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
15045 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
15046 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
15047 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
15048 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
15049 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015050
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015051 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
15052 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
15053 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015054
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015055 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015056 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015057
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015058 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
15059 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15060 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
15061 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020015062 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
15063 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015064 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
15065 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15066 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
15067 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15068 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
15069 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15070 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
15071 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080015072 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
15073 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15074 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015075 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15076 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
15077 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15078 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
15079 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015080
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010015081 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
15082 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
15083 the corresponding match text.
15084
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015085 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
15086 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
15087 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
15088 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
15089 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015090
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015091 Example :
15092
15093 # this is a comment and is ignored
15094 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
15095 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
15096 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
15097 | | | `---------- value
15098 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
15099 | `---------------------------- key
15100 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
15101
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015102mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015103 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15104 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015105 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015106 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015107 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015108 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15109 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15110 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15111 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015112 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015113 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015114
15115mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015116 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020015117 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
15118 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015119 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015120 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015121 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015122 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15123 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15124 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15125 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015126 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015127 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015128
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010015129nbsrv
15130 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
15131 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
15132 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
15133 map lookup.
15134
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015135neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015136 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
15137 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
15138 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
15139 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015140
15141not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015142 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015143 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015144 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015145 absence of a flag).
15146
15147odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015148 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015149 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
15150
15151or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015152 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015153 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015154 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15155 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015156 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015157 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15158 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15159 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15160 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015161 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015162 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015163
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015164protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
15165 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
15166 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
15167 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
15168 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
15169 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
15170 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
15171 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
15172 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
15173 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
15174 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
15175 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
15176
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010015177regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015178 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
15179 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
15180 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
15181 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
15182 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
15183 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
15184 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
15185 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
15186 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015187 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
15188 of characters with other ones.
15189
15190 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
15191 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
15192 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
15193 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
15194 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
15195 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015196
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015197 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015198
15199 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
15200 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
15201 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015202 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015203
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015204 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
15205 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
15206
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010015207 # capture groups and backreferences
15208 # both lines do the same.
15209 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)]'
15210 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
15211
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015212capture-req(<id>)
15213 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
15214 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15215
15216 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015217 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15218 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015219
15220capture-res(<id>)
15221 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
15222 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15223
15224 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015225 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15226 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015227
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020015228rtrim(<chars>)
15229 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
15230 of the input sample.
15231
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015232sdbm([<avalanche>])
15233 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
15234 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15235 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15236 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15237 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15238 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15239 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015240 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
15241 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015242
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020015243secure_memcmp(<var>)
15244 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
15245 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
15246 match.
15247
15248 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
15249 performed in constant time.
15250
15251 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15252 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15253
15254 Example :
15255
15256 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
15257 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
15258 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
15259 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
15260
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015261set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015262 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
15263 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
15264 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015265 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015266 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15267 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015268 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015269 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15270 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015271 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015272 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015273
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015274sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015275 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015276 sample with length of 20 bytes.
15277
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015278sha2([<bits>])
15279 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
15280 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
15281
15282 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
15283 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
15284
15285 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15286 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15287
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020015288srv_queue
15289 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
15290 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
15291 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
15292 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
15293 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
15294
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020015295strcmp(<var>)
15296 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
15297 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
15298 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
15299 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
15300 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
15301 shorter).
15302
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020015303 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
15304 strings in constant time.
15305
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020015306 Example :
15307
15308 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
15309 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
15310 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
15311
15312
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015313sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015314 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
15315 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015316 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015317 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
15318 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015319 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015320 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15321 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015322 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015323 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15324 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015325 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015326 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015327
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015328table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
15329 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15330 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15331 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
15332 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
15333 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
15334 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
15335
15336
15337table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
15338 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15339 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15340 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
15341 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
15342 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
15343 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
15344
15345table_conn_cnt(<table>)
15346 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15347 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015348 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015349 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
15350 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15351
15352table_conn_cur(<table>)
15353 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15354 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15355 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
15356 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
15357 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
15358
15359table_conn_rate(<table>)
15360 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15361 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15362 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
15363 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
15364 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
15365
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015366table_gpt0(<table>)
15367 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15368 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
15369 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
15370 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
15371 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
15372
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015373table_gpc0(<table>)
15374 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15375 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15376 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
15377 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
15378 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
15379
15380table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
15381 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15382 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15383 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
15384 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
15385 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
15386 sample fetch keyword.
15387
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015388table_gpc1(<table>)
15389 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15390 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15391 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
15392 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
15393 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
15394
15395table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
15396 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15397 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15398 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
15399 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
15400 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
15401 sample fetch keyword.
15402
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015403table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
15404 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15405 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015406 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015407 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
15408 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15409
15410table_http_err_rate(<table>)
15411 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15412 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15413 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
15414 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
15415 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
15416 keyword.
15417
15418table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
15419 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15420 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015421 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015422 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
15423 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15424
15425table_http_req_rate(<table>)
15426 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15427 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15428 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
15429 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
15430 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
15431 keyword.
15432
15433table_kbytes_in(<table>)
15434 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15435 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015436 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015437 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
15438 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
15439 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
15440 keyword.
15441
15442table_kbytes_out(<table>)
15443 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15444 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015445 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015446 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
15447 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
15448 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
15449 keyword.
15450
15451table_server_id(<table>)
15452 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15453 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15454 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
15455 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
15456 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
15457 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
15458
15459table_sess_cnt(<table>)
15460 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15461 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015462 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015463 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
15464 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
15465 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
15466 keyword.
15467
15468table_sess_rate(<table>)
15469 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15470 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15471 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
15472 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
15473 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
15474 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
15475 keyword.
15476
15477table_trackers(<table>)
15478 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15479 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15480 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
15481 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
15482 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
15483 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
15484 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
15485 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
15486 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
15487 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
15488
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015489upper
15490 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
15491 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15492 type. The result is of type string.
15493
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020015494url_dec([<in_form>])
15495 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
15496 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
15497 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
15498 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
15499 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
15500 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020015501
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015502ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015503 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015504 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
15505 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
15506 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015507 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
15508 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
15509 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
15510 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015511 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015512 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
15513 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015514
15515 Example:
15516 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
15517 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
15518
15519 message Point {
15520 int32 latitude = 1;
15521 int32 longitude = 2;
15522 }
15523
15524 message PPoint {
15525 Point point = 59;
15526 }
15527
15528 message Rectangle {
15529 // One corner of the rectangle.
15530 PPoint lo = 48;
15531 // The other corner of the rectangle.
15532 PPoint hi = 49;
15533 }
15534
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015535 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
15536 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
15537 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015538
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015539 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
15540 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015541 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015542 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
15543
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015544 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015545
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015546 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015547
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015548 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
15549 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
15550 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015551
15552 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
15553 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
15554 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
15555
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015556 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
15557 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
15558 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015559
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015560
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010015561unset-var(<var name>)
15562 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
15563 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
15564 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
15565 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15566 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
15567 response),
15568 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15569 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
15570 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
15571 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
15572
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015573utime(<format>[,<offset>])
15574 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15575 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
15576 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
15577 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
15578 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
15579 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
15580
15581 Example :
15582
15583 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015584 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015585 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
15586
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015587word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15588 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
15589 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
15590 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010015591 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015592 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
15593 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
15594
15595 Example :
15596 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
15597 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
15598 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
15599 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
15600 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010015601 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010015602
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015603wt6([<avalanche>])
15604 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
15605 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15606 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15607 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15608 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15609 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15610 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015611 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
15612 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015613
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015614xor(<value>)
15615 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015616 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015617 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015618 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015619 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015620 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15621 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015622 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015623 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15624 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015625 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015626 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015627
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010015628xxh32([<seed>])
15629 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
15630 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
15631 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
15632 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
15633 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
15634 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
15635 as cryptographically secure.
15636
15637xxh64([<seed>])
15638 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
15639 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
15640 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
15641 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
15642 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
15643 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
15644 as cryptographically secure.
15645
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015646
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200156477.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015648--------------------------------------------
15649
15650A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
15651not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
15652"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
15653The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
15654
15655always_false : boolean
15656 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
15657 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
15658
15659always_true : boolean
15660 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
15661 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
15662
15663avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015664 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015665 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
15666 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
15667 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
15668 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
15669 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
15670 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
15671 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
15672 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
15673 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
15674 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
15675 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
15676 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
15677 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010015678
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015679be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015680 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
15681 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
15682 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
15683 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040015684 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
15685
15686be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
15687 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
15688 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
15689 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
15690 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
15691 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040015692 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
15693 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040015694
15695 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
15696 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
15697 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015698
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015699be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
15700 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15701 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
15702 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015703 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015704 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
15705 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015706
15707 Example :
15708 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
15709 backend dynamic
15710 mode http
15711 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
15712 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015713
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015714bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015715 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
15716 of the string.
15717
15718bool(<bool>) : bool
15719 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
15720 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
15721
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015722connslots([<backend>]) : integer
15723 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015724 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015725 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
15726 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050015727
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015728 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015729 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015730 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
15731
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015732 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
15733 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015734
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015735 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015736 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015737 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015738 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015739 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015740 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015741 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015742
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015743 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
15744 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015745 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015746 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015747
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010015748cpu_calls : integer
15749 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
15750 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
15751 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
15752 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
15753 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
15754 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
15755
15756cpu_ns_avg : integer
15757 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
15758 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
15759 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
15760 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
15761 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
15762 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
15763 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
15764 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
15765 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
15766 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
15767 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
15768
15769cpu_ns_tot : integer
15770 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
15771 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
15772 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
15773 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
15774 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
15775 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
15776 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
15777 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
15778 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
15779 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
15780 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
15781 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
15782 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
15783
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010015784date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020015785 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015786
15787 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
15788 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
15789 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020015790 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
15791
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015792 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
15793 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
15794 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
15795 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
15796 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
15797
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020015798 Example :
15799
15800 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
15801 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020015802
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015803 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
15804 # millisecond granularity
15805 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
15806
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010015807date_us : integer
15808 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
15809 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
15810 from the same timeval structure.
15811
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020015812distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
15813 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
15814 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
15815 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
15816 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
15817 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
15818 list of supported tokens.
15819
15820distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
15821 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
15822 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
15823 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
15824 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
15825 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
15826 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
15827 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
15828 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
15829 supported tokens.
15830
15831 Example :
15832 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
15833 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
15834 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
15835 # send large files to the big farm
15836 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
15837
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020015838env(<name>) : string
15839 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
15840 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
15841 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
15842 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
15843 certain way.
15844
15845 Examples :
15846 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
15847 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
15848
15849 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
15850 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
15851
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015852fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
15853 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015854 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
15855 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015856 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
15857 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015858 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015859 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
15860 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015861
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020015862fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
15863 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
15864 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
15865 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
15866
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015867fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
15868 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15869 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
15870 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
15871 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
15872 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
15873 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
15874 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
15875 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015876
15877 Example :
15878 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
15879 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
15880 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
15881 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
15882 frontend mail
15883 bind :25
15884 mode tcp
15885 maxconn 100
15886 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
15887 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
15888 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
15889 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015890
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010015891hostname : string
15892 Returns the system hostname.
15893
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015894int(<integer>) : signed integer
15895 Returns a signed integer.
15896
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015897ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
15898 Returns an ipv4.
15899
15900ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
15901 Returns an ipv6.
15902
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010015903lat_ns_avg : integer
15904 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
15905 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
15906 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
15907 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
15908 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
15909 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
15910 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
15911 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
15912 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020015913 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
15914 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
15915 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
15916 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
15917 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
15918 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010015919
15920lat_ns_tot : integer
15921 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
15922 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
15923 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
15924 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
15925 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
15926 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
15927 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
15928 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
15929 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020015930 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
15931 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
15932 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
15933 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
15934 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010015935 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
15936 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
15937 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
15938 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
15939 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
15940 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
15941
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015942meth(<method>) : method
15943 Returns a method.
15944
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015945nbproc : integer
15946 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
15947 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
15948 and debugging purposes.
15949
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015950nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
15951 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
15952 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
15953 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015954 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
15955 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
15956 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015957
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040015958prio_class : integer
15959 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
15960 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
15961 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
15962
15963prio_offset : integer
15964 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
15965 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
15966 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
15967 set-priority-offset".
15968
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015969proc : integer
15970 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
15971 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
15972 debugging purposes.
15973
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015974queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015975 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
15976 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
15977 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015978 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
15979 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
15980 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
15981 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
15982 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
15983
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010015984rand([<range>]) : integer
15985 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
15986 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
15987 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
15988 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
15989 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
15990
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020015991uuid([<version>]) : string
15992 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
15993 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
15994 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
15995
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015996srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15997 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15998 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
15999 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
16000 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
16001 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040016002 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
16003 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
16004
16005srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16006 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
16007 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
16008 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
16009 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
16010 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
16011 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
16012 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
16013
16014 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
16015 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016016
16017srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
16018 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
16019 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
16020 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016021 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016022 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
16023 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
16024 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
16025
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020016026srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16027 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
16028 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
16029 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
16030 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
16031 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
16032 fetch methods.
16033
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016034srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16035 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16036 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016037 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016038 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
16039 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016040 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016041 overloading servers).
16042
16043 Example :
16044 # Redirect to a separate back
16045 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
16046 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
16047 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
16048
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016049stopping : boolean
16050 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
16051 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
16052 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
16053
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016054str(<string>) : string
16055 Returns a string.
16056
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016057table_avl([<table>]) : integer
16058 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
16059 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
16060
16061table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16062 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
16063 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
16064 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
16065
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010016066thread : integer
16067 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
16068 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
16069 and debugging purposes.
16070
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016071var(<var-name>) : undefined
16072 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016073 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
16074 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016075 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016076 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16077 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016078 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016079 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16080 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016081 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016082 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016083
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200160847.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016085----------------------------------
16086
16087The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
16088closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
16089methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
16090sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
16091TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016092the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
16093counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020016094"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
16095used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
16096can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
16097Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
16098table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
16099tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
16100currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016101
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010016102bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010016103 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16104 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16105 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
16106
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016107be_id : integer
16108 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016109 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16110 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016111
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016112be_name : string
16113 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016114 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16115 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016117dst : ip
16118 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
16119 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
16120 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
16121 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010016122 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
16123 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
16124 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
16125 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
16126 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
16127 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016128
16129dst_conn : integer
16130 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
16131 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
16132 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
16133 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
16134 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
16135 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
16136 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
16137 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016138
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016139dst_is_local : boolean
16140 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
16141 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
16142 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
16143 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016144 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016145 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
16146 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
16147 it only once per connection.
16148
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016149dst_port : integer
16150 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
16151 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
16152 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
16153 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
16154 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
16155 an HTTP header.
16156
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020016157fc_http_major : integer
16158 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16159 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16160 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
16161
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020016162fc_pp_authority : string
16163 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16164 if any.
16165
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010016166fc_pp_unique_id : string
16167 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16168 if any.
16169
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010016170fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
16171 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
16172 header.
16173
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020016174fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
16175 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
16176 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
16177 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
16178 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16179 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16180 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16181
16182fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
16183 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
16184 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
16185 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
16186 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16187 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16188 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16189
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016190fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016191 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16192 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16193 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16194 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16195
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016196fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016197 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16198 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16199 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16200 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16201
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016202fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016203 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
16204 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16205 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16206 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16207
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016208fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016209 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
16210 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16211 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16212 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16213
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016214fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016215 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
16216 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16217 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16218 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16219
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016220fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016221 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
16222 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16223 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16224 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16225
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020016226fe_defbe : string
16227 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
16228 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
16229
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016230fe_id : integer
16231 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010016232 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016233 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16234
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016235fe_name : string
16236 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
16237 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
16238 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16239
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016240sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016241sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16242sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16243sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016244 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
16245 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16246 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
16247
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016248sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016249sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16250sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16251sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016252 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
16253 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16254 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
16255
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016256sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016257sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16258sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16259sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016260 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16261 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016262 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16263 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16264 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016265
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016266 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016267 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
16268 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016269 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
16270 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
16271 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016272 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
16273 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16274
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016275sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16276sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16277sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16278sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16279 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16280 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
16281 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16282 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16283 when a first ACL was verified.
16284
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016285sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016286sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16287sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16288sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016289 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016290 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
16291
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016292sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016293sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
16294sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
16295sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016296 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
16297 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
16298 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
16299
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016300sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016301sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16302sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16303sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016304 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
16305 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
16306 See also src_conn_rate.
16307
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016308sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016309sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16310sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16311sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016312 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016313 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016314
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016315sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16316sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16317sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16318sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16319 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
16320 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
16321
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016322sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16323sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16324sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16325sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16326 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
16327 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
16328
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016329sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016330sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
16331sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
16332sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016333 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
16334 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
16335 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016336 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
16337 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16338 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016339
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016340sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16341sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16342sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16343sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16344 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
16345 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
16346 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
16347 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
16348 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16349 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
16350
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016351sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016352sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16353sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16354sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016355 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016356 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
16357 See also src_http_err_cnt.
16358
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016359sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016360sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16361sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16362sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016363 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
16364 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
16365 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
16366 src_http_err_rate.
16367
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016368sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016369sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16370sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16371sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016372 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016373 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
16374 src_http_req_cnt.
16375
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016376sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016377sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16378sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16379sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016380 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
16381 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
16382 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
16383 src_http_req_rate.
16384
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016385sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016386sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16387sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16388sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016389 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016390 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
16391 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
16392 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
16393 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016394
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016395 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016396 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
16397 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016398 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16399
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016400sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16401sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16402sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16403sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16404 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
16405 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
16406 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
16407 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
16408 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
16409
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016410sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016411sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
16412sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
16413sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016414 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
16415 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
16416 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016417
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016418sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016419sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
16420sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
16421sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016422 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
16423 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
16424 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016425
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016426sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016427sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16428sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16429sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016430 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016431 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
16432 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
16433 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016434 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016435 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
16436
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016437sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016438sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16439sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16440sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016441 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
16442 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
16443 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
16444 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
16445 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016446 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016447
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016448sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016449sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
16450sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
16451sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020016452 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
16453 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
16454 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
16455
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016456sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016457sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
16458sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
16459sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016460 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
16461 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016462 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016463 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
16464 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016465 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
16466 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
16467 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016468
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016469so_id : integer
16470 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
16471 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
16472 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016473
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010016474so_name : string
16475 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
16476 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
16477 strings instead of integers.
16478
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016479src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016480 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016481 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
16482 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
16483 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016484 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
16485 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
16486 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010016487 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
16488 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
16489 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
16490 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
16491 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
16492 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
16493 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016494
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016495 Example:
16496 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
16497 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
16498
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016499src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16500 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
16501 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
16502 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016503 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016504
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016505src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16506 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
16507 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016508 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016509 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016510
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016511src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16512 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16513 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16514 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
16515 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
16516 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
16517 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016518
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016519 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016520 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
16521 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
16522 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
16523 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016524 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016525 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
16526 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16527
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016528src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16529 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16530 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16531 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
16532 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
16533 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
16534 was verified.
16535
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016536src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016537 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016538 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016539 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016540 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016541
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016542src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016543 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016544 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
16545 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016546 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016547
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016548src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16549 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
16550 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16551 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016552 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016553
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016554src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016555 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016556 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016557 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016558 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016559
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016560src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16561 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
16562 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
16563 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
16564 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
16565
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016566src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16567 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
16568 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
16569 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
16570 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
16571
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016572src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016573 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016574 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016575 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
16576 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016577 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
16578 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16579 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016580
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016581src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16582 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
16583 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
16584 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
16585 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
16586 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
16587 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16588 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
16589
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016590src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016591 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016592 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016593 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016594 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016595 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016596
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016597src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16598 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
16599 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16600 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
16601 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016602 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016603
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016604src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016605 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016606 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
16607 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016608 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016609
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016610src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16611 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
16612 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
16613 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016614 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016615 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016616
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016617src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16618 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16619 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16620 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016621 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016622 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
16623 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016624
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016625 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016626 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016627 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016628 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016629
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016630src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16631 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16632 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16633 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
16634 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
16635 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
16636 connection when a first ACL was verified.
16637
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016638src_is_local : boolean
16639 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
16640 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
16641 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
16642 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016643 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016644 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
16645 once per connection.
16646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016647src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016648 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
16649 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
16650 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
16651 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
16652 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016653
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016654src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016655 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
16656 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16657 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
16658 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
16659 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016660
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016661src_port : integer
16662 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
16663 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
16664 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
16665 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016666
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016667src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016668 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016669 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16670 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
16671 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016672 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016673
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016674src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16675 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
16676 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16677 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
16678 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016679 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016680
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016681src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16682 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
16683 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
16684 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
16685 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
16686 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
16687 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
16688 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
16689 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016690
16691 Example :
16692 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
16693 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
16694 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
16695 listen ssh
16696 bind :22
16697 mode tcp
16698 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016699 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016700 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016701 server local 127.0.0.1:22
16702
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016703srv_id : integer
16704 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
16705 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016706 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020016707
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080016708srv_name : string
16709 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
16710 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016711 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080016712
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200167137.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016714----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020016715
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016716The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
16717closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
16718when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
16719usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016720future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020016721
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001672251d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
16723 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16724 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16725 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
16726 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16727 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
16728
16729 Example :
16730 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
16731 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
16732 # the request.
16733 frontend http-in
16734 bind *:8081
16735 default_backend servers
16736 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
16737 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
16738
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016739ssl_bc : boolean
16740 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
16741 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016742 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
16743 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016744
16745ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
16746 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016747 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
16748 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016749
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016750ssl_bc_alpn : string
16751 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
16752 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020016753 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016754 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
16755 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
16756 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
16757 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
16758 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016759 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
16760 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016761
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016762ssl_bc_cipher : string
16763 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016764 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
16765 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016766
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016767ssl_bc_client_random : binary
16768 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
16769 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16770 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016771 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016772
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010016773ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
16774 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16775 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016776 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
16777 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010016778
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016779ssl_bc_npn : string
16780 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
16781 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020016782 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016783 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
16784 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
16785 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
16786 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016787 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
16788 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016789
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016790ssl_bc_protocol : string
16791 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016792 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
16793 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016794
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016795ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016796 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016797 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016798 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
16799 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016800
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016801ssl_bc_server_random : binary
16802 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
16803 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16804 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016805 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016806
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016807ssl_bc_session_id : binary
16808 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
16809 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016810 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
16811 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016812
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016813ssl_bc_session_key : binary
16814 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
16815 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
16816 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016817 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016818
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016819ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
16820 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016821 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
16822 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016823
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016824ssl_c_ca_err : integer
16825 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16826 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
16827 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
16828 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
16829 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020016830
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016831ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
16832 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16833 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
16834 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
16835 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016836
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010016837ssl_c_der : binary
16838 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
16839 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16840 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
16841
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016842ssl_c_err : integer
16843 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16844 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
16845 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
16846 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
16847 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016848
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016849ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016850 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16851 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
16852 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16853 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16854 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16855 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16856 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16857 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016858 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16859 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16860 LDAP v3.
16861 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16862 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016863
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016864ssl_c_key_alg : string
16865 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
16866 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16867 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016868
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016869ssl_c_notafter : string
16870 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
16871 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16872 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016873
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016874ssl_c_notbefore : string
16875 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
16876 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16877 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010016878
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016879ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016880 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16881 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
16882 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16883 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16884 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16885 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16886 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16887 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016888 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16889 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16890 LDAP v3.
16891 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16892 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010016893
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016894ssl_c_serial : binary
16895 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
16896 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16897 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016898
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016899ssl_c_sha1 : binary
16900 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
16901 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
16902 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020016903 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
16904 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
16905
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016906 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020016907 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016908
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016909ssl_c_sig_alg : string
16910 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
16911 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16912 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016913
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016914ssl_c_used : boolean
16915 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
16916 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016917
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016918ssl_c_verify : integer
16919 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
16920 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
16921 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
16922 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016923
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016924ssl_c_version : integer
16925 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
16926 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016927
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010016928ssl_f_der : binary
16929 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
16930 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16931 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
16932
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016933ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016934 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16935 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
16936 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16937 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016938 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016939 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16940 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16941 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016942 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16943 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16944 LDAP v3.
16945 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16946 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016947
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016948ssl_f_key_alg : string
16949 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
16950 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
16951 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016952
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016953ssl_f_notafter : string
16954 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
16955 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16956 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016957
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016958ssl_f_notbefore : string
16959 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
16960 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16961 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016962
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016963ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016964 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16965 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
16966 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16967 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16968 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16969 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16970 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16971 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016972 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16973 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16974 LDAP v3.
16975 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16976 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016977
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016978ssl_f_serial : binary
16979 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
16980 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16981 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016982
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020016983ssl_f_sha1 : binary
16984 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
16985 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
16986 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
16987
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016988ssl_f_sig_alg : string
16989 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
16990 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16991 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016992
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016993ssl_f_version : integer
16994 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
16995 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16996
16997ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016998 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
16999 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
17000 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
17001
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017002 Example :
17003 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
17004 listen http-https
17005 bind :80
17006 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
17007 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
17008
17009ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
17010 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
17011 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
17012
17013ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017014 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017015 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
17016 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
17017 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
17018 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
17019 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
17020 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
17021 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
17022 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
17023
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017024ssl_fc_cipher : string
17025 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
17026 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020017027
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017028ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
17029 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
17030 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017031 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017032
17033ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
17034 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
17035 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017036 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017037
17038ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
17039 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
17040 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
17041 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017042 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020017043 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017044
17045ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
17046 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
17047 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017048 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017049
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017050ssl_fc_client_random : binary
17051 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
17052 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17053 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
17054
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020017055ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
17056 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17057 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17058 transport layer.
17059 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17060 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17061 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17062 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17063
17064ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
17065 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17066 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17067 transport layer.
17068 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17069 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17070 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17071 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17072
17073ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
17074 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
17075 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17076 transport layer.
17077 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17078 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17079 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17080 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17081
17082ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
17083 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17084 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17085 transport layer.
17086 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17087 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17088 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17089 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17090
17091ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
17092 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17093 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
17094 transport layer.
17095 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17096 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17097 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17098 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17099
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017100ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017101 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
17102 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010017103 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
17104 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
17105 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
17106 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017107
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020017108ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
17109 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
17110 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
17111 wait until the handshake happened.
17112
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017113ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
17114 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020017115 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
17116 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017117 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020017118 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017119
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020017120ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017121 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010017122 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
17123 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017125ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017126 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017127 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
17128 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
17129 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
17130 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
17131 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
17132 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
17133 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020017134
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017135ssl_fc_protocol : string
17136 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
17137 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017138
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017139ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017140 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017141 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
17142 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017143
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020017144ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
17145 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17146 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17147 transport layer.
17148 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17149 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17150 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17151 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17152
17153ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
17154 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
17155 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
17156 transport layer.
17157 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17158 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17159 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17160 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17161
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017162ssl_fc_server_random : binary
17163 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
17164 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17165 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
17166
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017167ssl_fc_session_id : binary
17168 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
17169 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
17170 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
17171 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017172
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017173ssl_fc_session_key : binary
17174 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
17175 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
17176 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
17177 BoringSSL.
17178
17179
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017180ssl_fc_sni : string
17181 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
17182 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
17183 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
17184 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
17185 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
17186
17187 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
17188 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
17189 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017190 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020017191 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017192
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017193 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017194 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
17195 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020017196
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017197ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
17198 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
17199 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017200
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017201ssl_s_der : binary
17202 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
17203 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17204 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17205
17206ssl_s_key_alg : string
17207 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17208 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
17209 SSL/TLS transport layer.
17210
17211ssl_s_notafter : string
17212 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
17213 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17214 transport layer.
17215
17216ssl_s_notbefore : string
17217 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
17218 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17219 transport layer.
17220
17221ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
17222 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17223 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17224 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17225 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17226 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17227 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020017228 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17229 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017230 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17231 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17232 LDAP v3.
17233 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17234 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
17235
17236ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
17237 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17238 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17239 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17240 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17241 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17242 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020017243 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17244 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017245 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17246 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17247 LDAP v3.
17248 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17249 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
17250
17251ssl_s_serial : binary
17252 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
17253 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17254 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17255
17256ssl_s_sha1 : binary
17257 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
17258 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
17259 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
17260
17261ssl_s_sig_alg : string
17262 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17263 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17264 layer.
17265
17266ssl_s_version : integer
17267 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
17268 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017269
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200172707.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017271------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017272
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017273Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
17274sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
17275only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
17276For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
17277be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
17278can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
17279sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
17280for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
17281content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017282
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017283payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017284 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017285 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
17286 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017287
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017288payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
17289 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017290 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017291 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017292
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020017293req.hdrs : string
17294 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
17295 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
17296 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
17297 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
17298
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020017299req.hdrs_bin : binary
17300 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
17301 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
17302 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
17303 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
17304 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
17305 names and values (length of 0 for both).
17306
17307 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
17308
17309 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
17310 str: <int:length><bytes>
17311
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017312req.len : integer
17313req_len : integer (deprecated)
17314 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
17315 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
17316 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
17317 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
17318 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
17319 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
17320 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
17321 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017322
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017323req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
17324 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017325 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
17326 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
17327 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
17328 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017329
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017330 ACL alternatives :
17331 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017332
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017333req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
17334 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
17335 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
17336 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
17337 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017338
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017339 ACL alternatives :
17340 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017341
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017342 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017343
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017344req.proto_http : boolean
17345req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
17346 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
17347 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
17348 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
17349 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
17350 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
17351 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
17352 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017353
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017354 Example:
17355 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
17356 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17357 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017358 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017359
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017360req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
17361rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17362 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
17363 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
17364 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
17365 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
17366 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
17367 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
17368 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017369
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017370 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
17371 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
17372 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
17373 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
17374 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
17375 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017376
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017377 ACL derivatives :
17378 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017379
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017380 Example :
17381 listen tse-farm
17382 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
17383 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
17384 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17385 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
17386 # apply RDP cookie persistence
17387 persist rdp-cookie
17388 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
17389 # This is only useful makes sense if
17390 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
17391 stick-table type string size 204800
17392 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
17393 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
17394 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017395
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017396 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
17397 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017398
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017399req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
17400rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
17401 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
17402 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
17403 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
17404 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017405
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017406 ACL derivatives :
17407 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017408
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017409req.ssl_alpn : string
17410 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
17411 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
17412 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
17413 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
17414 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
17415 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020017416 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017417
17418 Examples :
17419 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
17420 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17421 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020017422 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017423 default_backend bk_default
17424
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020017425req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
17426 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
17427 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020017428 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
17429 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
17430 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
17431 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
17432 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020017433
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017434req.ssl_hello_type : integer
17435req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
17436 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
17437 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
17438 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
17439 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
17440 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
17441 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
17442 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017443
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017444req.ssl_sni : string
17445req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
17446 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
17447 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
17448 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
17449 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
17450 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
17451 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
17452 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
17453 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
17454 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
17455 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
17456 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
17457 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017458
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017459 ACL derivatives :
17460 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017461
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017462 Examples :
17463 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
17464 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17465 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
17466 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
17467 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017468
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053017469req.ssl_st_ext : integer
17470 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
17471 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
17472 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
17473 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
17474 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
17475 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
17476 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
17477 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
17478 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
17479
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017480req.ssl_ver : integer
17481req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
17482 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
17483 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
17484 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
17485 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
17486 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
17487 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
17488 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017489 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017490 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017491
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017492 ACL derivatives :
17493 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017494
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020017495res.len : integer
17496 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
17497 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
17498 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
17499 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
17500 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
17501 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
17502 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017503 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020017504
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017505res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
17506 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017507 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017508 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017509 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017510 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017511
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017512res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
17513 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
17514 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
17515 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017516 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
17517 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017518
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017519 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017520
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020017521res.ssl_hello_type : integer
17522rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
17523 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
17524 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
17525 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
17526 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
17527 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
17528 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
17529 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
17530
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017531wait_end : boolean
17532 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
17533 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017534 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017535 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
17536 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017537 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017538 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
17539 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017540
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017541 Examples :
17542 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
17543 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
17544 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017545
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017546 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
17547 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17548 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
17549 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
17550 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
17551 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
17552 tcp-request content reject
17553
17554
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200175557.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017556--------------------------------------
17557
17558It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
17559This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
17560data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
17561its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
17562HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
17563content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
17564to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
17565more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
17566response are indexed.
17567
17568base : string
17569 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
17570 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
17571 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
17572 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
17573 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
17574 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
17575 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
17576 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
17577
17578 ACL derivatives :
17579 base : exact string match
17580 base_beg : prefix match
17581 base_dir : subdir match
17582 base_dom : domain match
17583 base_end : suffix match
17584 base_len : length match
17585 base_reg : regex match
17586 base_sub : substring match
17587
17588base32 : integer
17589 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
17590 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
17591 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017592 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
17593 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
17594 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017595
17596base32+src : binary
17597 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
17598 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
17599 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
17600 per-URL counters.
17601
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010017602capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
17603 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
17604 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
17605 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
17606
17607capture.req.method : string
17608 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
17609 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
17610 because it's allocated.
17611
17612capture.req.uri : string
17613 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
17614 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
17615 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
17616 allocated.
17617
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020017618capture.req.ver : string
17619 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
17620 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
17621 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
17622
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010017623capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
17624 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
17625 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
17626 The first entry is an index of 0.
17627 See also: "capture response header"
17628
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020017629capture.res.ver : string
17630 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
17631 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
17632 persistent flag.
17633
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017634req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017635 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
17636 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
17637 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017638
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020017639req.body_param([<name>) : string
17640 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
17641 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
17642 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
17643 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
17644 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
17645 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
17646 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
17647 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
17648 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
17649 given.
17650
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017651req.body_len : integer
17652 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
17653 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017654 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
17655 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017656
17657req.body_size : integer
17658 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017659 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
17660 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017661
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017662req.cook([<name>]) : string
17663cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17664 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17665 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
17666 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
17667 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
17668 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
17669 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
17670 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
17671 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
17672
17673 ACL derivatives :
17674 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
17675 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
17676 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
17677 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
17678 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
17679 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
17680 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
17681 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017682
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017683req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17684cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17685 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
17686 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017687
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017688req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
17689cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17690 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17691 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
17692 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
17693 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020017694
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017695cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17696 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17697 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
17698 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
17699 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020017700 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017701 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
17702 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
17703 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
17704 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017705
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017706hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17707 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
17708 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
17709 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
17710 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017711 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017712
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017713req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
17714 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
17715 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
17716 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17717 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17718 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17719 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
17720 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
17721 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017722
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017723req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17724 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
17725 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
17726 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
17727 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017728
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017729req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17730 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
17731 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
17732 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17733 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17734 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17735 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
17736 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
17737 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000017738 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017739 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017740 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017741
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017742 ACL derivatives :
17743 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
17744 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
17745 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
17746 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
17747 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
17748 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
17749 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
17750 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
17751
17752req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17753hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
17754 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
17755 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
17756 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
17757 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
17758 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
17759 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
17760 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
17761 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
17762 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
17763
17764req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
17765hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
17766 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
17767 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
17768 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
17769 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
17770 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017771 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017772 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
17773 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
17774
17775req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
17776hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
17777 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
17778 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
17779 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
17780 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17781 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17782 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17783 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
17784
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010017785
17786
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017787http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
17788 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
17789 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
17790 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
17791 basic auth is supported.
17792
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010017793http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
17794 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
17795 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
17796 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
17797 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017798 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
17799 basic auth is supported.
17800
17801 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010017802 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
17803 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
17804 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
17805 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017806
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017807http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010017808 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
17809 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
17810 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017811
17812http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010017813 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
17814 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
17815 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017816
17817http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010017818 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
17819 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
17820 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017822http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020017823 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
17824 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017825 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
17826 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020017827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017828method : integer + string
17829 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
17830 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
17831 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
17832 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
17833 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
17834 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
17835 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017836
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017837 ACL derivatives :
17838 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017839
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017840 Example :
17841 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
17842 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
17843 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017844
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017845path : string
17846 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
17847 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
17848 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
17849 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
17850 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017851 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017852 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017853
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017854 ACL derivatives :
17855 path : exact string match
17856 path_beg : prefix match
17857 path_dir : subdir match
17858 path_dom : domain match
17859 path_end : suffix match
17860 path_len : length match
17861 path_reg : regex match
17862 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017863
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010017864query : string
17865 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
17866 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
17867 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
17868 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017869 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010017870 which stops before the question mark.
17871
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010017872req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
17873 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
17874 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
17875 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
17876 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
17877
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017878req.ver : string
17879req_ver : string (deprecated)
17880 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
17881 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
17882 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017883
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017884 ACL derivatives :
17885 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020017886
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017887res.body : binary
17888 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
17889 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
17890 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
17891 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
17892
17893res.body_len : integer
17894 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
17895 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
17896 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
17897 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
17898
17899res.body_size : integer
17900 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
17901 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
17902 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
17903 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
17904 useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It may be used in tcp-check
17905 based expect rules.
17906
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017907res.comp : boolean
17908 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
17909 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
17910 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017911
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017912res.comp_algo : string
17913 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
17914 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
17915 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017916
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017917res.cook([<name>]) : string
17918scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17919 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
17920 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017921 specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may be used in tcp-check
17922 based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020017923
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017924 ACL derivatives :
17925 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020017926
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017927res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17928scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17929 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
17930 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017931 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses. It may
17932 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017933
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017934res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
17935scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17936 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
17937 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017938 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may
17939 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017940
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017941res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17942 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
17943 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
17944 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
17945 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
17946 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
17947 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
17948 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
17949 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017950 Expires. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017951
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017952res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17953 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
17954 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
17955 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
17956 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017957 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in
17958 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017959
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017960res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17961shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
17962 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
17963 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
17964 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
17965 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
17966 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
17967 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
17968 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017969 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in tcp-check based
17970 expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017971
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017972 ACL derivatives :
17973 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
17974 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
17975 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
17976 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
17977 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
17978 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
17979 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
17980 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
17981
17982res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17983shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17984 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
17985 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
17986 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
17987 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017988 instead. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017989
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017990res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
17991shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
17992 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
17993 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
17994 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
17995 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
17996 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017997 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table. It
17998 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017999
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018000res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
18001 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
18002 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
18003 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018004 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered. It may be used
18005 in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018006
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018007res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
18008shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
18009 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
18010 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
18011 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
18012 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
18013 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018014 useful to learn some data into a stick table. It may be used in tcp-check
18015 based expect rules.
18016
18017res.hdrs : string
18018 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
18019 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
18020 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
18021 headers analyzers and for advanced logging. It may also be used in tcp-check
18022 based expect rules.
18023
18024res.hdrs_bin : binary
18025 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
18026 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
18027 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
18028 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
18029 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
18030 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
18031 (length of 0 for both).
18032
18033 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
18034
18035 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
18036 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010018037
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018038res.ver : string
18039resp_ver : string (deprecated)
18040 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018041 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. It may be used in
18042 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018043
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018044 ACL derivatives :
18045 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010018046
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018047set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18048 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18049 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020018050 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018051 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018052
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018053 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
18054 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018055
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018056status : integer
18057 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
18058 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018059 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx. It may be used in
18060 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018061
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020018062unique-id : string
18063 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
18064 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
18065 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
18066 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
18067 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
18068 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
18069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018070url : string
18071 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
18072 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
18073 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
18074 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
18075 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
18076 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
18077 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018078
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018079 ACL derivatives :
18080 url : exact string match
18081 url_beg : prefix match
18082 url_dir : subdir match
18083 url_dom : domain match
18084 url_end : suffix match
18085 url_len : length match
18086 url_reg : regex match
18087 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018088
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018089url_ip : ip
18090 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
18091 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
18092 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
18093 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
18094 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
18095 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
18096 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018097
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018098url_port : integer
18099 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
18100 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
18101 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
18102 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018103
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018104urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
18105url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018106 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
18107 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018108 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
18109 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
18110 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
18111 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018112 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
18113 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018114 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
18115 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018117 ACL derivatives :
18118 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
18119 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
18120 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
18121 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
18122 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
18123 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
18124 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
18125 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018126
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018127
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018128 Example :
18129 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
18130 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
18131 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
18132 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018133
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018134urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018135 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
18136 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
18137 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020018138
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020018139url32 : integer
18140 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
18141 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
18142 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
18143 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
18144 is an unsigned integer.
18145
18146url32+src : binary
18147 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
18148 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
18149 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
18150
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020018151
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200181527.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018153---------------------------------------
18154
18155This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
18156used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
18157purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
18158There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
18159or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
18160any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
18161for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
18162
18163internal.htx.data : integer
18164 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
18165 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18166
18167internal.htx.free : integer
18168 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
18169 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18170
18171internal.htx.free_data : integer
18172 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
18173 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18174
18175internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
18176 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains an
18177 end-of-message block (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is
18178 chosen depending on the sample direction.
18179
18180internal.htx.nbblks : integer
18181 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
18182 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18183
18184internal.htx.size : integer
18185 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
18186 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18187
18188internal.htx.used : integer
18189 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
18190 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18191 direction.
18192
18193internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
18194 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18195 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
18196 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
18197 of the special value :
18198 * head : The oldest inserted block
18199 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018200 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018201
18202internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
18203 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18204 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
18205 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
18206 integer or one of the special value :
18207 * head : The oldest inserted block
18208 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018209 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018210
18211internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
18212 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18213 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
18214 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18215 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18216
18217 * head : The oldest inserted block
18218 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018219 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018220
18221internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
18222 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
18223 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
18224 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18225 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18226
18227 * head : The oldest inserted block
18228 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018229 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018230
18231internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
18232 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
18233 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
18234 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18235 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18236
18237 * head : The oldest inserted block
18238 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018239 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018240
18241internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
18242 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
18243 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
18244 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18245 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18246
18247 * head : The oldest inserted block
18248 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018249 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018250
18251internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
18252 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
18253 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
18254 it returns false.
18255
18256
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200182577.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018258---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018259
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018260Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
18261every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020018262order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018263
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018264ACL name Equivalent to Usage
18265---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018266FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020018267HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018268HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
18269HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018270HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
18271HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
18272HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
18273HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
18274LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018275METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020018276METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018277METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
18278METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
18279METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
18280METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020018281METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018282METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018283RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018284REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018285TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018286WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
18287---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018288
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010018289
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182908. Logging
18291----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018292
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018293One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
18294provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
18295very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
18296provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
18297state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018298to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018299headers.
18300
18301In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
18302about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
18303send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
18304
18305 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
18306 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
18307 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
18308 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
18309 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018310 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060018311 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018312
18313The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
18314allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
18315as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
18316while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
18317real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
18318delay.
18319
18320
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183218.1. Log levels
18322---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018323
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018324TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018325source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018326HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
18327in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
18328track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
18329syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
18330about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018331
18332
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183338.2. Log formats
18334----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018335
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018336HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018337and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
18338slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
18339options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018340
18341 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
18342 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
18343 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
18344 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
18345 extents.
18346
18347 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
18348 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
18349 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
18350 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
18351 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
18352
18353 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
18354 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
18355 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
18356 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
18357 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
18358
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020018359 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
18360 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
18361 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
18362 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
18363
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018364 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
18365
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018366Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
18367specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
18368field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
18369servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
18370always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
18371identifier.
18372
18373Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
18374 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
18375 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
18376 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
18377 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
18378
18379
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183808.2.1. Default log format
18381-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018382
18383This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
18384as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
18385format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
18386
18387 Example :
18388 listen www
18389 mode http
18390 log global
18391 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18392
18393 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
18394 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
18395 (www/HTTP)
18396
18397 Field Format Extract from the example above
18398 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
18399 2 'Connect from' Connect from
18400 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
18401 4 'to' to
18402 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
18403 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
18404
18405Detailed fields description :
18406 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
18407 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
18408 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
18409 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
18410 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18411 and processed the connection.
18412 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
18413
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018414In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
18415"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
18416connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
18417
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018418It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
18419will eventually disappear.
18420
18421
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200184228.2.2. TCP log format
18423---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018424
18425The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
18426is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
18427information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
18428counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
18429emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
18430environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
18431the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
18432sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018433specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
18434not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
18435fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
18436marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018437
18438 Example :
18439 frontend fnt
18440 mode tcp
18441 option tcplog
18442 log global
18443 default_backend bck
18444
18445 backend bck
18446 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18447
18448 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
18449 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
18450 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
18451
18452 Field Format Extract from the example above
18453 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
18454 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
18455 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
18456 4 frontend_name fnt
18457 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
18458 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
18459 7 bytes_read* 212
18460 8 termination_state --
18461 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
18462 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
18463
18464Detailed fields description :
18465 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018466 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
18467 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
18468 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018469 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018470 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018471 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018472
18473 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018474 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
18475 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
18476 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018477
18478 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
18479 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
18480 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018481 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
18482 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
18483 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
18484 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018485
18486 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18487 and processed the connection.
18488
18489 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
18490 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
18491 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
18492 applications.
18493
18494 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
18495 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
18496 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
18497 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
18498 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
18499
18500 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
18501 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
18502 See "Timers" below for more details.
18503
18504 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
18505 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
18506 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
18507 "Timers" below for more details.
18508
18509 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018510 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018511 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
18512 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
18513 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
18514 details.
18515
18516 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
18517 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
18518 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
18519 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
18520 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
18521
18522 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
18523 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
18524 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
18525 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
18526 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
18527 for more details.
18528
18529 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018530 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018531 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
18532 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
18533 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018534 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018535
18536 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
18537 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
18538 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
18539 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
18540 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
18541 caused by a denial of service attack.
18542
18543 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
18544 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
18545 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
18546 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
18547 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
18548 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
18549 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
18550 denial of service attack.
18551
18552 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
18553 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
18554 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
18555 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
18556 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
18557 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
18558 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
18559 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
18560 be processed than on other servers.
18561
18562 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
18563 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
18564 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
18565 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
18566 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
18567 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
18568 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
18569 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
18570 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
18571 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
18572 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
18573 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
18574 should not be attributed to the logged server.
18575
18576 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18577 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
18578 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
18579 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
18580 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
18581 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018582 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018583 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
18584
18585 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18586 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
18587 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
18588 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
18589 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
18590 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018591 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018592 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
18593 occurs.
18594
18595
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200185968.2.3. HTTP log format
18597----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018598
18599The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
18600is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
18601the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
18602are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
18603emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
18604generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
18605"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
18606which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018607frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
18608is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018609
18610Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
18611slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
18612with a star ('*') after the field name below.
18613
18614 Example :
18615 frontend http-in
18616 mode http
18617 option httplog
18618 log global
18619 default_backend bck
18620
18621 backend static
18622 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18623
18624 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
18625 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
18626 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018627 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018628
18629 Field Format Extract from the example above
18630 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
18631 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018632 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018633 4 frontend_name http-in
18634 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018635 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018636 7 status_code 200
18637 8 bytes_read* 2750
18638 9 captured_request_cookie -
18639 10 captured_response_cookie -
18640 11 termination_state ----
18641 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
18642 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
18643 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
18644 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
18645 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018646
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018647Detailed fields description :
18648 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018649 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
18650 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
18651 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018652 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018653 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018654 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018655
18656 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018657 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
18658 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
18659 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018660
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018661 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
18662 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018663
18664 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18665 and processed the connection.
18666
18667 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
18668 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
18669 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
18670
18671 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
18672 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
18673 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
18674 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
18675 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
18676 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
18677
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018678 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
18679 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
18680 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018681 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018682 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
18683 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018684 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
18685 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018686
18687 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
18688 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018689 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018690
18691 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
18692 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018693 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
18694 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018695
18696 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
18697 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
18698 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
18699 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
18700 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018701 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
18702 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018703
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018704 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
18705 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
18706 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
18707 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
18708 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
18709 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
18710 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018711 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018712
18713 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
18714 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
18715 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
18716
18717 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
18718 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018719 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018720 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
18721 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
18722 overflowing.
18723
18724 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
18725 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
18726 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
18727 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
18728 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
18729 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
18730 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
18731 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
18732
18733 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
18734 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
18735 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
18736 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
18737 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
18738 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
18739 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
18740 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
18741
18742 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
18743 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
18744 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
18745 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
18746 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
18747 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
18748 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
18749
18750 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018751 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018752 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
18753 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
18754 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018755 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018756 system.
18757
18758 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
18759 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
18760 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
18761 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
18762 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
18763 caused by a denial of service attack.
18764
18765 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
18766 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
18767 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
18768 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
18769 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
18770 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
18771 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
18772 denial of service attack.
18773
18774 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
18775 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
18776 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
18777 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
18778 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
18779 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
18780 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
18781 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
18782 processed than on other servers.
18783
18784 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
18785 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
18786 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
18787 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
18788 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
18789 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
18790 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
18791 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
18792 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
18793 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
18794 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
18795 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
18796 should not be attributed to the logged server.
18797
18798 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18799 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
18800 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
18801 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
18802 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
18803 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018804 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018805 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
18806
18807 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18808 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
18809 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
18810 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
18811 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
18812 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018813 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018814 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
18815 occurs.
18816
18817 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
18818 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
18819 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
18820 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
18821 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
18822 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
18823 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
18824 cookies" below for more details.
18825
18826 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
18827 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
18828 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
18829 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
18830 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
18831 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
18832 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
18833 and cookies" below for more details.
18834
18835 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
18836 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
18837 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
18838 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
18839 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
18840 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
18841 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
18842 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
18843
18844
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200188458.2.4. Custom log format
18846------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018847
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018848The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018849mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018850
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018851HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018852Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
18853separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
18854prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
18855
18856Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
18857variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018858("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018859
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010018860If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020018861as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010018862less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
18863the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
18864
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020018865Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
18866"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
18867delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
18868preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018869
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018870Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
18871'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
18872https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
18873such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
18874
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018875Flags are :
18876 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018877 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018878 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
18879 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018880
18881 Example:
18882
18883 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
18884 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
18885
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018886 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
18887
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018888At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
18889
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018890 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
18891 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018892
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018893the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018894
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018895 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
18896 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
18897 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018898
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018899and the default TCP format is defined this way :
18900
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018901 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
18902 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018903
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018904Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
18905
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018906 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018907 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018908 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
18909 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
18910 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018911 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
18912 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
18913 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018914 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000018915 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
18916 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000018917 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000018918 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
18919 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010018920 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020018921 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018922 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018923 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018924 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020018925 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080018926 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018927 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
18928 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
18929 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
18930 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
18931 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018932 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018933 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000018934 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018935 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018936 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018937 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
18938 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018939 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
18940 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
18941 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018942 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018943 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
18944 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018945 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018946 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
18947 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
18948 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020018949 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020018950 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020018951 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
18952 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
18953 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
18954 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020018955 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018956 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018957 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018958 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010018959 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018960 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018961 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
18962 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
18963 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018964 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018965 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
18966 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018967 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018968 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
18969 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020018970 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018971 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018972 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018973 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018974
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018975 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018976
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010018977
189788.2.5. Error log format
18979-----------------------
18980
18981When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
18982protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
18983By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
18984"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018985will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010018986logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
18987
18988The format looks like this :
18989
18990 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
18991 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
18992 Connection error during SSL handshake
18993
18994 Field Format Extract from the example above
18995 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
18996 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
18997 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
18998 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
18999 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
19000
19001These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
19002failures.
19003
19004
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190058.3. Advanced logging options
19006-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019007
19008Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
19009just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
19010options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
19011for more information about their usage.
19012
19013
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190148.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
19015------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019016
19017It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
19018haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
19019commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
19020monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
19021ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
19022
19023 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
19024 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
19025 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
19026 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
19027
19028 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
19029 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
19030 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019031 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019032 such as other load-balancers.
19033
19034 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
19035 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
19036 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
19037
19038
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190398.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
19040----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019041
19042The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
19043what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
19044or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019045"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019046just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
19047log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
19048after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
19049is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
19050with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
19051with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
19052
19053
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190548.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
19055------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019056
19057Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
19058for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
19059"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
19060retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
19061raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
19062a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
19063file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
19064you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
19065"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
19066
19067
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190688.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
19069--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019070
19071Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
19072multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
19073them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
19074"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
19075logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
19076error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
19077and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
19078too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
19079useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
19080alternative.
19081
19082
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190838.4. Timing events
19084------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019085
19086Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
19087reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
19088the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
19089frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019090mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
19091addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
19092
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010019093Timings events in HTTP mode:
19094
19095 first request 2nd request
19096 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
19097 t tr t tr ...
19098 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
19099 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
19100 :<---- Tq ---->: :
19101 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019102 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010019103 :<--------- Ta --------->:
19104
19105Timings events in TCP mode:
19106
19107 TCP session
19108 |<----------------->|
19109 t t
19110 ---|----|----|----|----|---
19111 | Th Tw Tc Td |
19112 |<------ Tt ------->|
19113
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019114 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019115 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019116 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
19117 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
19118 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019119 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019120 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
19121 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
19122 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
19123 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019124
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019125 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
19126 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
19127 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019128 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
19129 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
19130 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
19131 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
19132 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
19133 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019134
19135 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
19136 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
19137 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
19138 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
19139 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
19140 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
19141 request typed by hand during a test.
19142
19143 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
19144 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019145 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019146 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
19147 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
19148 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
19149 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019150
19151 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
19152 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
19153 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
19154 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
19155 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
19156
19157 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
19158 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
19159 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
19160 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
19161 connection never established.
19162
19163 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
19164 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
19165 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
19166 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
19167 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
19168 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
19169 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
19170 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
19171 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
19172 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
19173 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
19174
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019175 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
19176 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
19177 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
19178 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
19179 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
19180 by subtracting other timers when valid :
19181
19182 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
19183
19184 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
19185 "Ta" can never be negative.
19186
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019187 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
19188 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019189 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
19190 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019191 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019192
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019193 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019194
19195 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019196 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
19197 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019198
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019199 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
19200 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
19201 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
19202 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
19203 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
19204 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
19205 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
19206 prefixed with a '+' sign.
19207
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019208These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
19209protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
19210that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019211due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
19212"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
19213that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019214
19215Most common cases :
19216
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019217 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
19218 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
19219 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
19220 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
19221 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
19222 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
19223 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
19224 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
19225 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
19226 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
19227 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020019228 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019229
19230 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
19231 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
19232 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
19233 of ms on remote networks.
19234
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019235 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
19236 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
19237 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019238
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019239 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
19240 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
19241 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
19242 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
19243 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
19244 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
19245 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
19246 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
19247 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019248
19249Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
19250
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019251 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019252 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019253 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019254
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019255 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019256 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
19257 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
19258
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019259 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019260 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
19261 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
19262 flags.
19263
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019264 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
19265 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019266 Check the session termination flags, then check the
19267 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
19268 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
19269 the client connection was maintained open.
19270
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019271 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019272 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019273 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019274 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
19275
19276
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200192778.5. Session state at disconnection
19278-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019279
19280TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
19281"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
192822-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
19283each of which has a special meaning :
19284
19285 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
19286 session to terminate :
19287
19288 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
19289
19290 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
19291 server explicitly refused it.
19292
19293 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
19294 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
19295 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
19296 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019297 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020019298
19299 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
19300 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019301
19302 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
19303 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
19304 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
19305 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
19306 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
19307
19308 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
19309 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
19310 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
19311 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
19312 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
19313
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090019314 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
19315 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
19316
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070019317 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
19318 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
19319 backup connections when going up.
19320
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020019321 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
19322
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019323 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
19324 send or receive data.
19325
19326 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
19327 send or receive data.
19328
19329 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
19330 with nothing left in the buffers.
19331
19332 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
19333
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010019334 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019335 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
19336
19337 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
19338 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
19339 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
19340 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
19341 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
19342
19343 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
19344 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
19345
19346 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
19347 server (HTTP only).
19348
19349 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
19350
19351 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
19352 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
19353 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
19354
19355 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
19356 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
19357 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
19358
19359 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
19360
19361 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
19362 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
19363
19364 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
19365 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
19366 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
19367
19368 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
19369 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020019370 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
19371 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019372
19373 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
19374 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
19375 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
19376 another server.
19377
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019378 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019379 server.
19380
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019381 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
19382 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
19383 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
19384 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
19385
19386 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
19387 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
19388 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
19389 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
19390
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020019391 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
19392 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
19393 "use-server" rule).
19394
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019395 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
19396
19397 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
19398 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
19399
19400 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
19401
19402 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
19403 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
19404 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
19405
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019406 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
19407 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019408 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019409 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
19410 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
19411
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019412 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
19413
19414 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
19415 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
19416
19417 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
19418
19419 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
19420
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019421The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
19422was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019423helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
19424starvation, attacks, etc...
19425
19426The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
19427alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
19428easier finding and understanding.
19429
19430 Flags Reason
19431
19432 -- Normal termination.
19433
19434 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
19435 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
19436 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
19437 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
19438
19439 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
19440 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
19441 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
19442 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
19443 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
19444 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019445
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019446 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
19447 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020019448 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019449
19450 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
19451 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
19452 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
19453
19454 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
19455 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
19456 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
19457 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
19458 the server takes too long to respond.
19459
19460 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
19461 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
19462 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
19463 long a time to respond.
19464
19465 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
19466 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
19467 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
19468 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019469 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
19470 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019471
19472 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
19473 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
19474 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
19475 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
19476 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020019477 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019478 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
19479 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
19480 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
19481 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
19482 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
19483 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
19484 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
19485 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019486 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019487 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
19488 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
19489 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019490
19491 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
19492 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019493 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
19494 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
19495 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
19496 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019497
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020019498 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
19499 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
19500
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019501 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019502 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
19503 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019504 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019505 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
19506 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
19507
19508 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
19509 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
19510 503 or 504 here.
19511
19512 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
19513 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
19514 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
19515 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
19516 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
19517
19518 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
19519 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019520 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019521 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
19522 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
19523
19524 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
19525 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
19526 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
19527 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
19528 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
19529 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
19530 between haproxy and the server.
19531
19532 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
19533 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
19534 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
19535 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
19536 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
19537 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
19538 solution is to fix the application.
19539
19540 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
19541 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
19542 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
19543 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
19544 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
19545 external attacks.
19546
19547 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
19548 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020019549 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019550 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
19551 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
19552
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019553 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
19554 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
19555 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019556 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020019557 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019558
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019559 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
19560 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
19561 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
19562 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019563 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
19564 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
19565 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
19566 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
19567 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019568
19569 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
19570 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
19571 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
19572 returned an HTTP 403 error.
19573
19574 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
19575 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
19576 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
19577 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
19578
19579 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
19580 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
19581 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
19582 only be solved by proper system tuning.
19583
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019584The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
19585persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
19586important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
19587re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
19588
19589 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
19590
19591 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
19592 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
19593 set on a GET request.
19594
19595 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
19596 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019597 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019598 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
19599
19600 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
19601 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
19602 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
19603
19604 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
19605 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
19606 already got a cookie.
19607
19608 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
19609 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
19610 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
19611 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
19612 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
19613
19614 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
19615 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
19616 new cookie was inserted in the response.
19617
19618 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
19619 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
19620 new cookie was inserted in the response.
19621
19622 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
19623 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
19624
19625 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
19626 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
19627 then advertised in the response.
19628
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019629
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200196308.6. Non-printable characters
19631-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019632
19633In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
19634consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
19635converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
19636prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
19637being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
19638escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
19639is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
19640'}' when logging headers.
19641
19642Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
19643issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
19644containing spaces is "User-Agent".
19645
19646Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
19647the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
19648performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
19649
19650
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200196518.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
19652---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019653
19654Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
19655achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019656section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019657cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
19658the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
19659the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019660locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019661not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
19662user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
19663a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
19664wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
19665
19666 Examples :
19667 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
19668 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
19669
19670 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
19671 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
19672
19673
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200196748.8. Capturing HTTP headers
19675---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019676
19677Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
19678proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
19679the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
19680server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
19681
19682Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
19683response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019684section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019685
19686It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019687time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
19688appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019689are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
19690and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
19691follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
19692request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
19693in the logs.
19694
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020019695As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
19696frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
19697an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
19698
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019699 Example :
19700 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
19701 listen proxy-out
19702 mode http
19703 option httplog
19704 option logasap
19705 log global
19706 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
19707
19708 # log the name of the virtual server
19709 capture request header Host len 20
19710
19711 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
19712 capture request header Content-Length len 10
19713
19714 # log the beginning of the referrer
19715 capture request header Referer len 20
19716
19717 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
19718 capture response header Server len 20
19719
19720 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
19721 capture response header Content-Length len 10
19722
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019723 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019724 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
19725
19726 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
19727 capture response header Via len 20
19728
19729 # log the URL location during a redirection
19730 capture response header Location len 20
19731
19732 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
19733 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
19734 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
19735 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
19736 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
19737
19738 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
19739 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
19740 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
19741 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019742 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019743
19744 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
19745 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
19746 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
19747 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
19748 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019749 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019750
19751
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200197528.9. Examples of logs
19753---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019754
19755These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
19756them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
19757reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
19758
19759 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
19760 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
19761 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
19762
19763 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
19764 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
19765
19766 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
19767 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
19768 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
19769
19770 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
19771 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
19772
19773 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
19774 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
19775 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
19776
19777 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019778 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019779 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
19780 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
19781
19782 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
19783 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
19784 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
19785
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020019786 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
19787 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
19788 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
19789 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
19790 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
19791 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019792
19793 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019794 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019795
19796 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
19797 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
19798 Nothing was sent to any server.
19799
19800 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
19801 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
19802
19803 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
19804 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019805 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019806 send a 408 return code to the client.
19807
19808 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
19809 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
19810
19811 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
19812 5 seconds ("c----").
19813
19814 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
19815 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019816 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019817
19818 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019819 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019820 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
19821 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
19822 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
19823 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
19824 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010019825
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020019826
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200198279. Supported filters
19828--------------------
19829
19830Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
19831accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
19832unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
19833
19834See also : "filter"
19835
198369.1. Trace
19837----------
19838
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010019839filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019840
19841 Arguments:
19842 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
19843 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
19844
19845 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
19846 the client and the server. By default, this filter
19847 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
19848 only parses a random amount of the available data.
19849
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019850 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019851 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
19852 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
19853 amount of the parsed data.
19854
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019855 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010019856
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019857This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
19858callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
19859information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
19860filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
19861
19862Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
19863tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
19864a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
19865
19866
198679.2. HTTP compression
19868---------------------
19869
19870filter compression
19871
19872The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
19873keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019874when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
19875fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
19876done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
19877explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
19878filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
19879listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
19880order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019881
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019882See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
19883 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019884
19885
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200198869.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
19887--------------------------------------------
19888
19889filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
19890
19891 Arguments :
19892
19893 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
19894 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
19895 parsed.
19896
19897 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
19898 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
19899 part must be placed in its own scope.
19900
19901The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
19902external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019903streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020019904exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
19905also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
19906
19907SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
19908the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
19909
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010019910For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020019911"doc/SPOE.txt".
19912
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100199139.4. Cache
19914----------
19915
19916filter cache <name>
19917
19918 Arguments :
19919
19920 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
19921
19922The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
19923"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019924cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019925other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
19926case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
19927is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
19928filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010019929listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
19930order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010019931
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019932See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
19933 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
19934
19935
199369.5. Fcgi-app
19937-------------
19938
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040019939filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019940
19941 Arguments :
19942
19943 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
19944
19945The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
19946request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
19947reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
19948used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
19949implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
19950used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
19951fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
19952used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
19953order.
19954
19955See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
19956 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
19957
19958
1995910. FastCGI applications
19960-------------------------
19961
19962HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
19963feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
19964the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
19965FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
19966servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
19967FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
19968backend.
19969
19970HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
19971application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
19972connection.
19973
1997410.1. Setup
19975-----------
19976
1997710.1.1. Fcgi-app section
19978--------------------------
19979
19980fcgi-app <name>
19981 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
19982 document root must be defined.
19983
19984acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
19985 Declare or complete an access list.
19986
19987 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
19988 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
19989 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
19990 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
19991 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
19992
19993docroot <path>
19994 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
19995 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
19996 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
19997
19998index <script-name>
19999 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
20000 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
20001 is an optional setting.
20002
20003 Example :
20004 index index.php
20005
20006log-stderr global
20007log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
20008 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
20009 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
20010
20011 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
20012 default STDERR messages are ignored.
20013
20014pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
20015 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
20016 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
20017 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
20018
20019 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
20020 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
20021 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
20022 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
20023
20024 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
20025 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
20026
20027path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020028 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010020029 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
20030 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
20031 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
20032 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
20033 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
20034 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
20035 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020036
20037 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020038 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020039 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
20040 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
20041 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
20042 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020043
20044 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010020045 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
20046 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020047
20048option get-values
20049no option get-values
20050 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
20051
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040020052 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020053 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
20054
20055 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
20056 application will accept.
20057
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020020058 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
20059 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020060
20061 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050020062 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020063 option is disabled.
20064
20065 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
20066 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
20067 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
20068 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
20069 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
20070 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
20071
20072option keep-conn
20073no option keep-conn
20074 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
20075 sending a response.
20076
20077 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
20078 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
20079
20080option max-reqs <reqs>
20081 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
20082 accept.
20083
20084 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
20085 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
20086 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
20087 to 1.
20088
20089option mpxs-conns
20090no option mpxs-conns
20091 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
20092
20093 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
20094 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
20095
20096set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
20097 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
20098 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
20099 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
20100 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
20101
20102 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
20103 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
20104 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
20105
20106 Example :
20107 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
20108 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
20109
20110 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
20111
20112
2011310.1.2. Proxy section
20114---------------------
20115
20116use-fcgi-app <name>
20117 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
20118
20119 Arguments :
20120 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
20121
20122 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
20123 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
20124 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
20125 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
20126 application may be defined at a time per backend.
20127
20128 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
20129 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
20130 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
20131 application are evaluated.
20132
20133
2013410.1.3. Example
20135---------------
20136
20137 frontend front-http
20138 mode http
20139 bind *:80
20140 bind *:
20141
20142 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
20143 default_backend back-static
20144
20145 backend back-static
20146 mode http
20147 server www A.B.C.D:80
20148
20149 backend back-dynamic
20150 mode http
20151 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
20152 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
20153
20154 fcgi-app php-fpm
20155 log-stderr global
20156 option keep-conn
20157
20158 docroot /var/www/my-app
20159 index index.php
20160 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
20161
20162
2016310.2. Default parameters
20164------------------------
20165
20166A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
20167the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020168script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020169applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
20170
20171 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20172 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
20173 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
20174 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
20175 | | |
20176 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20177 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
20178 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
20179 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
20180 | | application. |
20181 | | |
20182 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20183 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
20184 | | the request. It may not be set. |
20185 | | |
20186 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20187 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
20188 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
20189 | | the application's configuration. |
20190 | | |
20191 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20192 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
20193 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
20194 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
20195 | | |
20196 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20197 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
20198 | | following the part that identifies the script |
20199 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
20200 | | be defined. |
20201 | | |
20202 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20203 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
20204 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
20205 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
20206 | | is not set too. |
20207 | | |
20208 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20209 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
20210 | | set. |
20211 | | |
20212 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20213 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
20214 | | the request. |
20215 | | |
20216 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20217 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
20218 | | client as part of user authentication. |
20219 | | |
20220 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20221 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
20222 | | script to process the request. |
20223 | | |
20224 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20225 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
20226 | | |
20227 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20228 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
20229 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
20230 | | |
20231 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20232 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
20233 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
20234 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
20235 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
20236 | | |
20237 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20238 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
20239 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
20240 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
20241 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
20242 | | side. |
20243 | | |
20244 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20245 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
20246 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
20247 | | connected to. |
20248 | | |
20249 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20250 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
20251 | | |
20252 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20253 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
20254 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
20255 | | |
20256 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20257
20258
2025910.3. Limitations
20260------------------
20261
20262The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
20263way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
20264during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
20265establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
20266application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
20267or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
20268message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
20269these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
20270and HTTP servers under the same backend.
20271
20272Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
20273request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
20274requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
20275
20276About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
20277into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
20278fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
20279"http-request" ones.
20280
20281Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
20282FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
20283processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
20284must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
20285here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010020286
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010020287/*
20288 * Local variables:
20289 * fill-column: 79
20290 * End:
20291 */